blob: fd68d9e5767a99353d221b9e80c592e5e39b0b3c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100489 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100490 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100491 - tune.lua.session-timeout
492 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100493 - tune.maxaccept
494 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200495 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200496 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200497 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100498 - tune.rcvbuf.client
499 - tune.rcvbuf.server
500 - tune.sndbuf.client
501 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100502 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100503 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200504 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100505 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200506 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100507 - tune.zlib.memlevel
508 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100509
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510 * Debugging
511 - debug
512 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516------------------------------------
517
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200518ca-base <dir>
519 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200520 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
521 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200522
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523chroot <jail dir>
524 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
525 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
526 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
527 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
528 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
529 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100530
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100531cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
532 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
533 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
534 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100535 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
536 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
537 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
538 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
539 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
540 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
541 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
542 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
543 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
544 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100545
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200546crt-base <dir>
547 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
548 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
549 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551daemon
552 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
553 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
554 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
555
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900556external-check
557 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
558 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
559 See "option external-check".
560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561gid <number>
562 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
563 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
564 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100565 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
566 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100568
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569group <group name>
570 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
571 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200573log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
575 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 configured with "log global".
577
578 <address> can be one of:
579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100580 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100581 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
582 port).
583
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100584 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
585 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
586 port).
587
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100588 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
589 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
590 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
591 writeable).
592
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100593 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
594 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
595 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
596 in Bourne shell.
597
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200598 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
599 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
600 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
601 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
602 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
603 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
604 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
605 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
606 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
607 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
608 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
609
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100610 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611
612 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
613 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
614 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
615
616 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200617 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
618 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
619 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
620 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
621 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
622 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200624 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100626log-send-hostname [<string>]
627 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
628 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
629 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
630 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
631 the logs.
632
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000633log-tag <string>
634 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
635 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
636 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100637 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000638
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100639lua-load <file>
640 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
641 used multiple times.
642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643nbproc <number>
644 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
645 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
646 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
647 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
648 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
649
650pidfile <pidfile>
651 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
652 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
653 starting the process. See also "daemon".
654
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100655stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
657 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
658 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
659 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
660 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
661 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100662 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200663 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
664 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200665
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100666ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300669 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100670 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
671 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
672 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
673 "bind" keyword for more information.
674
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100675ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
677 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
678 keyword to see available options.
679
680 Example:
681 global
682 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
683
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100684ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
686 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300687 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100688 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
689 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
690 information.
691
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100692ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
694 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
695 keyword to see available options.
696
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100697ssl-server-verify [none|required]
698 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
699 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
700 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
701
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200702stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
703 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
704 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
705 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
706 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200707
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200708 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
709 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
710 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200711
712stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
713 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
714 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100715 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200716
717stats maxconn <connections>
718 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
719 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721uid <number>
722 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
723 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
724 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
725 one. See also "gid" and "user".
726
727ulimit-n <number>
728 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
729 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
730 option.
731
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100732unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
733 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
734
735 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
736 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
737 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
738 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
739 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
740 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
741 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
742 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
743 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
744 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
745
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746user <user name>
747 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
748 See also "uid" and "group".
749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200750node <name>
751 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
752
753 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
754 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
755 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
756 traffic.
757
758description <text>
759 Add a text that describes the instance.
760
761 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
762 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
763 "<" and ">" characters.
764
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767-----------------------
768
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200769max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
770 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
771 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
772 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
773 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
774 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
775 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
776 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
777 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
778
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779maxconn <number>
780 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
781 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
782 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200783 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
784 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
785 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
786 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100787 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
788 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
789 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
790 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
791 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200793maxconnrate <number>
794 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
795 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
796 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
797 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
798 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
799 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
800 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
801 fairness.
802
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100803maxcomprate <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300805 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100806 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
807 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
808 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
809 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
810 default value.
811
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100812maxcompcpuusage <number>
813 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
814 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
815 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
816 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
817 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
818 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
819 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
820 process down and from introducing high latencies.
821
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100822maxpipes <number>
823 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
824 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
825 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
826 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
827 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
828 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
829
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200830maxsessrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
832 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
833 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
834 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
835 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
836 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
837 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
838 fairness.
839
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200840maxsslconn <number>
841 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
842 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
843 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
844 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
845 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
846 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
847 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100848 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
849 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
850 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
851 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
852 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
853 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
854 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200855
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200856maxsslrate <number>
857 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
858 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
859 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
860 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
861 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
862 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
863 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
864 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
865 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
866 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
867
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100868maxzlibmem <number>
869 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
870 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
871 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100872 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
873 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
874 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
875
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200876noepoll
877 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
878 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100879 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880
881nokqueue
882 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
883 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
884 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
885
886nopoll
887 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
888 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100889 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100890 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100892nosplice
893 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
894 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
895 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100896 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100897 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
898 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
899 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
900 "option splice-response".
901
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300902nogetaddrinfo
903 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
904 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
905
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200906spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900907 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
908 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
909 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
910 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
911 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
912 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200913
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100914tune.buffers.limit <number>
915 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
916 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
917 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
918 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
919 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
920 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
921 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
922 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
923 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
924 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
925 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
926 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
927 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
928 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
929 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
930
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100931tune.buffers.reserve <number>
932 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
933 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
934 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
935 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
936
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200937tune.bufsize <number>
938 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
939 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
940 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
941 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
942 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
943 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
944 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
945 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400946 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
947 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
948 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200949
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200950tune.chksize <number>
951 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
952 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
953 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
954 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
955 checks whenever possible.
956
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100957tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
958 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
959 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
960 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
961 this value. The default value is 1.
962
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100963tune.http.cookielen <number>
964 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
965 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
966 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
967 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
968 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
969 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
970 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
971 to change this value.
972
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200973tune.http.maxhdr <number>
974 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
975 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
976 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
977 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
978 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
979 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
980 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
981 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
982 limit too high.
983
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100984tune.idletimer <timeout>
985 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
986 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
987 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
988 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
989 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
990 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
991 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
992 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
993 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
994
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100995tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
996 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
997 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
998 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
999 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1000 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1001 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1002 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1003
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001004tune.lua.maxmem
1005 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1006 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1007 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1008 memory.
1009
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001010tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1011 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1012 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1013 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1014 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1015 4s.
1016
1017tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1018 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1019 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1020 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1021 check servers.
1022
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001023tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001024 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1025 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1026 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1027 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1028 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1029 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1030 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1031 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1032 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1033 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001034
1035tune.maxpollevents <number>
1036 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1037 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1038 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1039 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1040 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1041
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001042tune.maxrewrite <number>
1043 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1044 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1045 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1046 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1047 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1048 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1049 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1050 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1051 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1052 bufsize.
1053
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001054tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1055 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1056 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1057 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1058 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1059 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1060 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1061 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1062 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1063 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1064 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1065 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1066 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1067 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1068 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1069 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1070 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1071 setting this parameter to 0.
1072
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001073tune.pipesize <number>
1074 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1075 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1076 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1077 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1078 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1079 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1080
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001081tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1082tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1083 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1084 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1085 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1086 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1087 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1088 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1089 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1090
1091tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1092tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1093 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1094 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1095 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1096 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1097 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1098 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1099 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1100 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1101 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1102 notifying haproxy again.
1103
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001104tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001105 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1106 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1107 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001108 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001109 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1110 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1111 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1112 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1113 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001114 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1115 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001116
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001117tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1118 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1119 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1120 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1121 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1122 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1123 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1124
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001125tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1126 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001127 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001128 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1129 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1130 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1131 being used for too long.
1132
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001133tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1134 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1135 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1136 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1137 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1138 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1139 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1140 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1141 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1142 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1143 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001144 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1145 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001146
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001147tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1148 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1149 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1150 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1151 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1152 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1153 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1154 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1155 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1156
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001157tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1158 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001159 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001160 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1161 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1162 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1163
1164tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1165 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1166 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1167 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1168 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011703.3. Debugging
1171--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001172
1173debug
1174 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1175 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1176 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1177 system startup.
1178
1179quiet
1180 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1181 line argument "-q".
1182
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011843.4. Userlists
1185--------------
1186It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1187http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1188it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1189
1190userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001191 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001192 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1193
1194group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001195 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001196 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1197 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001199user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1200 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001201 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1202 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001203 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1204 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001205 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001206 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001207
1208
1209 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001210 userlist L1
1211 group G1 users tiger,scott
1212 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001213
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001214 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1215 user scott insecure-password elgato
1216 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001218 userlist L2
1219 group G1
1220 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001221
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001222 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1223 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1224 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001225
1226 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001227
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001228
12293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001230----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001231It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1232haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1233pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1234identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1235or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1236Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1237known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1238the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1239process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1240during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1241tables.
1242
1243peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001244 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001245 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1246
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001247disabled
1248 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1249 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1250 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1251
1252enable
1253 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001255peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1256 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1257 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1258 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1259 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1260 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1261 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1262
1263 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1264 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1265
1266 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1267 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1268 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1269 across all peers.
1270
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001271 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1272 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1273 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1274
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001275 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001276 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001277 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1278 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1279 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001280
1281 backend mybackend
1282 mode tcp
1283 balance roundrobin
1284 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1285 stick on src
1286
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001287 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1288 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001289
1290
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012913.6. Mailers
1292------------
1293It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1294If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1295in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1296
1297mailer <mailersect>
1298 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1299 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1300
1301mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1302 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1303
1304 Example:
1305 mailers mymailers
1306 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1307 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1308
1309 backend mybackend
1310 mode tcp
1311 balance roundrobin
1312
1313 email-alert mailers mymailers
1314 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1315 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1316
1317 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1318 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1319
1320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001324Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1325 - defaults <name>
1326 - frontend <name>
1327 - backend <name>
1328 - listen <name>
1329
1330A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1331its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1332section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001333section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334
1335A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1336connections.
1337
1338A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1339to forward incoming connections.
1340
1341A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1342parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1345'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1346case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1347
1348Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1349logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1350proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1351However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1352name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1353
1354Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1355and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001356bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001357protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1358modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1359arbitrary criteria.
1360
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001361In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1362a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1363the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1364
1365 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1366 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1367 between responses and new requests.
1368
1369 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1370 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1371 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1372 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1373
1374 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1375 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1376 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1377
1378 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1379 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1380 client-facing connection remains open.
1381
1382 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1383 after the end of the response.
1384
1385The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1386frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1387following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1388weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1389
1390 Backend mode
1391
1392 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1393 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1394 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1395 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1396 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1397 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1398 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1399 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1400 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1401 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1402 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1407--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001409The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1410limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1411they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1412limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001413marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001414option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001415and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1416with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1417specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001418
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001420 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1421------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1422acl - X X X
1423appsession - - X X
1424backlog X X X -
1425balance X - X X
1426bind - X X -
1427bind-process X X X X
1428block - X X X
1429capture cookie - X X -
1430capture request header - X X -
1431capture response header - X X -
1432clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001433compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1435cookie X - X X
1436default-server X - X X
1437default_backend X X X -
1438description - X X X
1439disabled X X X X
1440dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001441email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001442email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001443email-alert mailers X X X X
1444email-alert myhostname X X X X
1445email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001446enabled X X X X
1447errorfile X X X X
1448errorloc X X X X
1449errorloc302 X X X X
1450-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1451errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001452force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453fullconn X - X X
1454grace X X X X
1455hash-type X - X X
1456http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001457http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001458http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001460http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001461http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001463ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001464log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001465log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001466log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001467max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001468maxconn X X X -
1469mode X X X X
1470monitor fail - X X -
1471monitor-net X X X -
1472monitor-uri X X X -
1473option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1474option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1475option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1476option allbackups (*) X - X X
1477option checkcache (*) X - X X
1478option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1479option contstats (*) X X X -
1480option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1481option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1482option forceclose (*) X X X X
1483-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1484option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001485option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001486option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001487option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001488option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001489option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001490option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1491option httpchk X - X X
1492option httpclose (*) X X X X
1493option httplog X X X X
1494option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001495option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001496option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001497option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001498option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1499option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1500option logasap (*) X X X -
1501option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001502option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001503option nolinger (*) X X X X
1504option originalto X X X X
1505option persist (*) X - X X
1506option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001507option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001508option smtpchk X - X X
1509option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1510option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1511option splice-request (*) X X X X
1512option splice-response (*) X X X X
1513option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1514option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1515-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001516option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001517option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1518option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1519option tcpka X X X X
1520option tcplog X X X X
1521option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001522external-check command X - X X
1523external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001524persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1525rate-limit sessions X X X -
1526redirect - X X X
1527redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1528redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1529reqadd - X X X
1530reqallow - X X X
1531reqdel - X X X
1532reqdeny - X X X
1533reqiallow - X X X
1534reqidel - X X X
1535reqideny - X X X
1536reqipass - X X X
1537reqirep - X X X
1538reqisetbe - X X X
1539reqitarpit - X X X
1540reqpass - X X X
1541reqrep - X X X
1542-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1543reqsetbe - X X X
1544reqtarpit - X X X
1545retries X - X X
1546rspadd - X X X
1547rspdel - X X X
1548rspdeny - X X X
1549rspidel - X X X
1550rspideny - X X X
1551rspirep - X X X
1552rsprep - X X X
1553server - - X X
1554source X - X X
1555srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001556stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001557stats auth X - X X
1558stats enable X - X X
1559stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001560stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001561stats realm X - X X
1562stats refresh X - X X
1563stats scope X - X X
1564stats show-desc X - X X
1565stats show-legends X - X X
1566stats show-node X - X X
1567stats uri X - X X
1568-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1569stick match - - X X
1570stick on - - X X
1571stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001572stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001573stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001574tcp-check connect - - X X
1575tcp-check expect - - X X
1576tcp-check send - - X X
1577tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001578tcp-request connection - X X -
1579tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001580tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001581tcp-response content - - X X
1582tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001583timeout check X - X X
1584timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001585timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001586timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1587timeout connect X - X X
1588timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1589timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1590timeout http-request X X X X
1591timeout queue X - X X
1592timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001593timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001594timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1595timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001596timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001597transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001598unique-id-format X X X -
1599unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001600use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001601use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001602------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1603 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016064.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1607---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001608
1609This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1610
1611
1612acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1613 Declare or complete an access list.
1614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1615 no | yes | yes | yes
1616 Example:
1617 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1618 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1619 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001621 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001622
1623
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001624appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1625 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1628 no | no | yes | yes
1629 Arguments :
1630 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1631 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1632
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001633 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634 checked in each cookie value.
1635
1636 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1637 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1638 milliseconds.
1639
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001640 request-learn
1641 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1642 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1643 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1644 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1645 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1646 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1647
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001648 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1649 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1650 data following this prefix.
1651
1652 Example :
1653 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1654
1655 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1656 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1657
1658 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1659 2 modes are currently supported :
1660 - path-parameters :
1661 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1662 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1663 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1664 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1665 - query-string :
1666 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1667 query string.
1668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001669 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1670 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1671 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1672 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001673 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1674 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1675 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001676 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1677 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1678
1679 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1680
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001681 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1682 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1683 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685 Example :
1686 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1687
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001688 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1689 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
1691
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001692backlog <conns>
1693 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1695 yes | yes | yes | no
1696 Arguments :
1697 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1698 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001699 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001700
1701 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1702 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1703 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1704 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1705 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1706 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1707 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1708 backlog parameter.
1709
1710 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1711 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1712 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1713
1714 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1715
1716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001717balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001718balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1721 yes | no | yes | yes
1722 Arguments :
1723 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1724 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1725 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1726 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1727
1728 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1729 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1730 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1731 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001732 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001733 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001734 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1735 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1736 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1737 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1738 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1739 it, so that you don't worry.
1740
1741 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1742 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1743 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1744 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1745 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1746 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1747 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1748 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001750 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1751 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1752 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1753 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1754 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1755 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1756 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1757 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1758
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001759 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001760 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001761 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1762 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001763 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001764 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1765 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1766 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1767 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1768 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001769 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1770 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1771 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1772 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1773 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1774 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001775
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1777 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1778 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1779 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1780 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1781 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1782 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1783 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001784 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001786 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1787 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1788 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001790 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1791 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1792 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1793 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1794 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1795 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1796 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1797 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1798 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1799 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1800 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1801 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001803 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001804 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1805 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1806 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1807 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1808 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1809 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1810 URIs start with a leading "/".
1811
1812 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1813 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1814 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1815 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001818 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1819
1820 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001821 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1822 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001823 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1824 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1825 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1826 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001827 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001828 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1829 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001830
1831 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1832 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1833 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1834 server will receive the request.
1835
1836 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1837 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1838 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1839 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1840 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001841 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1842 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1843 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001845 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1846 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1847 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1848 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1849 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001851 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001852 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1853 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1854 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1855
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001856 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1857 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1858 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1859
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001860 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001861 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001862 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1863 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1864 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1865 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1866 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1867 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001868 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001869 used instead.
1870
1871 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1872 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1873 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1874 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1875
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001876 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1877 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1878 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1879
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001880 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001882 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001883 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1884 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001885
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001886 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1887 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1888 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
1890 Examples :
1891 balance roundrobin
1892 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001893 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001894 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1895 balance hdr(host)
1896 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001897
1898 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1899 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001901 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001902 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1903 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1904 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1905 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1906
1907 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1908 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1909 defaults to 16 kB.
1910
1911 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1912 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1913
1914 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1915 Round Robin.
1916
1917 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1918 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1919 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1920 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1921
1922 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1923
1924 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001925 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001926 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1927 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1928 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001929
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001930 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1931 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001932
1933
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001934bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1935bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1938 no | yes | yes | no
1939 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001940 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1941 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1942 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1943 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001944 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001945 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1946 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1947 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1948 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1949 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1950 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1951 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001952 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1953 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1954 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1955 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1956 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1957 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1958 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001959 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1960 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1961 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001962 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1963 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1964 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1965 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001966
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001967 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1968 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001969 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1970 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1971 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001972 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1973 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1974 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1975 the range.
1976
1977 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1978 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1979 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1980 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1981 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1982 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1983 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001984 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001985 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001987 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1988 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1989 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1990 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1991 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1992 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1993 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1994 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1995
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001996 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1997 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1998 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1999 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002000
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2002 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2003 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2004 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2005 in a frontend.
2006
2007 Example :
2008 listen http_proxy
2009 bind :80,:443
2010 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002011 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002013 listen http_https_proxy
2014 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002015 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002016
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002017 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2018 bind ipv6@:80
2019 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2020 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2021
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002022 listen external_bind_app1
2023 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
2024
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002025 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002026 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027
2028
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002029bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002030 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2032 yes | yes | yes | yes
2033 Arguments :
2034 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2035 may be used to override a default value.
2036
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002037 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002038 option may be combined with other numbers.
2039
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002040 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002041 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2042 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2043 missing from all processes.
2044
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002045 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002046 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002047 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2048 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2049 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2050 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002051
2052 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2053 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2054 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2055 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2056 and 'even' instances.
2057
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002058 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2059 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2060 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2061 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002062
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002063 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2064 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2065
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002066 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2067 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2068 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2069
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002070 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2071 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2072
2073 Example :
2074 listen app_ip1
2075 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002076 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002077
2078 listen app_ip2
2079 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002080 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002081
2082 listen management
2083 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002084 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002085
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002086 listen management
2087 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2088 bind-process 1-4
2089
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002090 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002091
2092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093block { if | unless } <condition>
2094 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 no | yes | yes | yes
2097
2098 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2099 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002100 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002101 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2103 "block" statements per instance.
2104
2105 Example:
2106 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2107 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2108 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2109 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002111 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002112
2113
2114capture cookie <name> len <length>
2115 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2117 no | yes | yes | no
2118 Arguments :
2119 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2120 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2121 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2122 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2123 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2124
2125 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2126 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2127 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2128 right if it exceeds <length>.
2129
2130 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2131 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2132 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2133 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2134
2135 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2136 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2137 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2138
2139 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2140 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2141 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002142 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2143 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2144 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
2146 Example:
2147 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2148
2149 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002150 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151
2152
2153capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002154 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2156 no | yes | yes | no
2157 Arguments :
2158 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002159 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002160 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2161 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2162 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2163
2164 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2165 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2166 it exceeds <length>.
2167
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002168 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2170 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002171 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2172 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2173 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2174 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002175 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002176 environments to find where the request came from.
2177
2178 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2179 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2180 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2181 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002183 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2184 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2185 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2186 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2187 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002188
2189 Example:
2190 capture request header Host len 15
2191 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2192 capture request header Referrer len 15
2193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002194 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002195 about logging.
2196
2197
2198capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002199 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2201 no | yes | yes | no
2202 Arguments :
2203 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002204 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2206 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2207 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2208
2209 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2210 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2211 it exceeds <length>.
2212
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002213 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2215 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2216 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002217 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2218 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2219 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2220 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002222 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2223 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2224 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2225 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2226 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002227
2228 Example:
2229 capture response header Content-length len 9
2230 capture response header Location len 15
2231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002232 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002233 about logging.
2234
2235
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002236clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2239 yes | yes | yes | no
2240 Arguments :
2241 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2242 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2243 as explained at the top of this document.
2244
2245 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2246 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2247 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2248 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2249 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2250 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2251 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2252 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002253 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2255 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2256
2257 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2258 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2259 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2260 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2261 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2262 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2263
2264 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2265 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2266
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002267 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2268 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002270compression algo <algorithm> ...
2271compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002272compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002273 Enable HTTP compression.
2274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2275 yes | yes | yes | yes
2276 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002277 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2278 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2279 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2280
2281 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002282 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2283 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2284 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002285
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002286 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2287 support for zlib was built in.
2288
2289 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2290 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2291 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2292 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2293 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2294 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002295
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002296 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2297 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2298 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2299 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2300 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2301 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2302 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2303 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002304
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002305 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002306 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002307 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2308 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2309 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2310 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2311 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002312
2313 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2314 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2315 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2316 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2317 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002318 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2319 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2320 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2321 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2322 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002323 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2324 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002325
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002326 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002327 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2328 "Accept-Encoding" header
2329 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002330 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002331 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2332 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002333 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2334 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2335 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2336 "multipart"
2337 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2338 header
2339 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2340 and later
2341 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2342 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002343
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002344 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2345 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002346
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002347 Examples :
2348 compression algo gzip
2349 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002350
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002351contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2354 yes | no | yes | yes
2355 Arguments :
2356 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2357 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2358 as explained at the top of this document.
2359
2360 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002361 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002362 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2364 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2365 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2366 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2367
2368 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2369 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2370 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2371 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2372 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2373 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2374
2375 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2376 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2377 instead.
2378
2379 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2380 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2381
2382
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002383cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002384 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2385 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2388 yes | no | yes | yes
2389 Arguments :
2390 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2391 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2392 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2393 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2394 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2395 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2396 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2397 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2398 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2399
2400 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2401 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2402 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2403 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2404 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2405 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2406 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2407 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2408 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2409 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2410 "insert" and "prefix".
2411
2412 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002413 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002414
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002415 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002416 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2417 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2418 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2419 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2420 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2421 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2422 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2423 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2424 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2425 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002426
2427 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2428 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2429 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2430 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2431 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2432 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2433 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2434 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2435 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2436 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002437 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2438 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2439 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002441 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2442 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2443 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002444 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2445 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2446 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2447 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002448 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2449 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2450 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
2452 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2453 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2454 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2455 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2456 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2457 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2458 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2459 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2460 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2461
2462 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2463 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2464 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2465 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2466 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2467 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2468 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2469 persistence cookie in the cache.
2470 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2471
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002472 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2473 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2474 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2475 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2476 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2477 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2478 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2479 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2480 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2481 they logout.
2482
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002483 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2484 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2485 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2486 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2487
2488 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2489 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2490 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2491 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2492 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2493 this attribute.
2494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002495 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002496 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002497 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2498 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2499 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2500 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2501 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2502 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002503
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002504 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2505 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2506 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2507 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2508 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2509 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2510 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2511 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2512 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2513 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2514 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2515 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2516 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2517 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2518 the site.
2519
2520 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2521 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2522 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2523 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2524 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2525 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2526 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2527 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2528 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2529 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2530 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2531 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2532 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2533 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2534 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2535 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2538 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2539 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2540 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542 Examples :
2543 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2544 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2545 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002546 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002548 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002549 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002552default-server [param*]
2553 Change default options for a server in a backend
2554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2555 yes | no | yes | yes
2556 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002557 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2558 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2559 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2560 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002561
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002562 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002563 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2564
2565 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568default_backend <backend>
2569 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2571 yes | yes | yes | no
2572 Arguments :
2573 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2574
2575 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2576 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2577 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2578 will catch all undetermined requests.
2579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580 Example :
2581
2582 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2583 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2584 default_backend dynamic
2585
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002586 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002589description <string>
2590 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2592 no | yes | yes | yes
2593 Arguments : string
2594
2595 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2596 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2597 it describes.
2598 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2599
2600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601disabled
2602 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2604 yes | yes | yes | yes
2605 Arguments : none
2606
2607 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2608 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2609 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2610 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2611 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2612 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2613 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2614
2615 See also : "enabled"
2616
2617
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002618dispatch <address>:<port>
2619 Set a default server address
2620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2621 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002622 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002623
2624 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2625 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2626 during start-up.
2627
2628 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2629 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2630 possible with normal servers.
2631
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002632 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002633 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2634 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2635 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2636 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2637
2638 See also : "server"
2639
2640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641enabled
2642 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2644 yes | yes | yes | yes
2645 Arguments : none
2646
2647 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2648 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2649
2650 See also : "disabled"
2651
2652
2653errorfile <code> <file>
2654 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | yes | yes | yes
2657 Arguments :
2658 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002659 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2660 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661
2662 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002663 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002664 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002665 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2666 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
2668 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2669 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2670 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2671
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002672 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2675 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2676 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2677 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2678
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002679 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2680 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2681 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2682 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2683 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2684 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2687 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2688 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002689 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2691
2692 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2693
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002694 Example :
2695 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002696 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002697 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2698 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002700
2701errorloc <code> <url>
2702errorloc302 <code> <url>
2703 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2705 yes | yes | yes | yes
2706 Arguments :
2707 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002708 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002709
2710 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2711 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2712 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2713 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2714 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2715
2716 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2717 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2718 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2719
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002720 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2721
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002722 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2723 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2724 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2725 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2726 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2727 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2728 request.
2729
2730 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2731
2732
2733errorloc303 <code> <url>
2734 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2736 yes | yes | yes | yes
2737 Arguments :
2738 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2739 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2740
2741 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2742 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2743 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2744 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2745 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2746
2747 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2748 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2749 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2750
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002751 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2752
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002753 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2754 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2755 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2756 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002757 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002758
2759 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2760
2761
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002762email-alert from <emailaddr>
2763 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2764 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2765 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2766 yes | yes | yes | yes
2767
2768 Arguments :
2769
2770 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2771
2772 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2773 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2774
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002775 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2776 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2777
2778
2779email-alert level <level>
2780 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2781 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2783 yes | yes | yes | yes
2784
2785 Arguments :
2786
2787 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2788 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2789 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2790
2791 By default level is alert
2792
2793 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2794 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2795 for the proxy.
2796
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002797 Alerts are sent when :
2798
2799 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2800 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2801 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2802 is notice or lower
2803 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2804 and a health check status update occurs
2805
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002806 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2807 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002808 section 3.6 about mailers.
2809
2810
2811email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2812 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2814 yes | yes | yes | yes
2815
2816 Arguments :
2817
2818 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2819
2820 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2821 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2822
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002823 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2824 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002825
2826
2827email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2828 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2829 mailers.
2830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2831 yes | yes | yes | yes
2832
2833 Arguments :
2834
2835 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2836
2837 By default the systems hostname is used.
2838
2839 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2840 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2841 for the proxy.
2842
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002843 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2844 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002845
2846
2847email-alert to <emailaddr>
2848 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2849 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2851 yes | yes | yes | yes
2852
2853 Arguments :
2854
2855 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2856
2857 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2858 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2859
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002860 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002861 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2862
2863
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002864force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2865 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 no | yes | yes | yes
2868
2869 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2870 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2871 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2872 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2873 marked down for maintenance operations.
2874
2875 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2876 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2877 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2878 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2879 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2880 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2881 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2882 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2883 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2884
2885 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2886 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2887 is used.
2888
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002889 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002890 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002891
2892
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002893fullconn <conns>
2894 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2896 yes | no | yes | yes
2897 Arguments :
2898 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2899 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2900
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002901 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002902 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002903 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002904 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2905 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2906 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2907 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2908 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002909 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002910
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002911 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2912 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002913 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2914 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2915 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002916
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002917 Example :
2918 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2919 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2920 # connections.
2921 backend dynamic
2922 fullconn 10000
2923 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2924 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2925
2926 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2927
2928
2929grace <time>
2930 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002932 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002933 Arguments :
2934 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2935 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2936 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2937
2938 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2939 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002940 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002941 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2942
2943 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2944 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2945 simplify it.
2946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002948hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002949 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | no | yes | yes
2952 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002953 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2954 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002955
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002956 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2957 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2958 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2959 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2960 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2961 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2962 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2963 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2964 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2965 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002966
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002967 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2968 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2969 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2970 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2971 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2972 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2973 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2974 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2975 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2976 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2977 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2978 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2979 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002980 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2981 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002982
2983 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2984
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002985 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002986 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2987 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2988 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002989 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2990 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2991 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002992
2993 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2994 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002995 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2996 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2997 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2998 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2999
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003000 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3001 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3002 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3003 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3004 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3005 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3006 parameter.
3007
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003008 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3009 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3010 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3011 used on strings.
3012
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003013 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3014
3015 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3016 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3017 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3018 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3019 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3020 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3021 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3022 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3023 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3024 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3025 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3026 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003027
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003028 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3029 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3030 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003031
3032 See also : "balance", "server"
3033
3034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035http-check disable-on-404
3036 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003038 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003039 Arguments : none
3040
3041 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3042 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3043 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3044 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3045 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3046 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3047 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3048 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003049 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3050 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3051 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3052
3053 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3054
3055
3056http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003057 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003059 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003060 Arguments :
3061 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3062 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003063 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003064 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3065 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3066 details on the supported keywords.
3067
3068 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3069 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3070 with the usual backslash ('\').
3071
3072 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3073 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3074 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3075 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3076 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3077
3078 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003079 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003080 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3081 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3082 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3083
3084 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003085 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003086 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3087 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3088 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3089 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3090
3091 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003092 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003093 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3094 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3095 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3096 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3097 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3098 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3099 trace).
3100
3101 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003102 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003103 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3104 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3105 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3106 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3107 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3108 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3109
3110 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3111 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3112 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3113 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3114 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3115 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3116 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3117 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3118
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003119 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3120 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3121 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3122
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003123 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3124 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3125
3126 Examples :
3127 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003128 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003129
3130 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003131 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003132
3133 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003134 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003135
3136 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003137 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003139 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003140
3141
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003142http-check send-state
3143 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3145 yes | no | yes | yes
3146 Arguments : none
3147
3148 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3149 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3150 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3151 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3152 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3153
3154 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3155 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3156 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3157 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3158 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003159 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3160 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3161 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3162
3163 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3164 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3165 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3166
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003167 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3168 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3169 checked in multiple backends.
3170
3171 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3172 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3173
3174 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3175 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3176 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3177 one fails.
3178
3179 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3180 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3181 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3182
3183 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3184 server's queue.
3185
3186 Example of a header received by the application server :
3187 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3188 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3189
3190 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3191
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003192http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003193 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003194 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003195 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3196 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003197 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3198 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003199 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3200 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3201 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003202 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003203 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3204 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003205 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003206 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003207 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3208
3209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3210 no | yes | yes | yes
3211
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003212 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3213 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3214 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3215 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3216 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003217
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003218 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3219 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3220 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3221
3222 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3223 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3224 are evaluated.
3225
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003226 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3227 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3228 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3229 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3230 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3231 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3232 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3233 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3234 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003235 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003236 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3237
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003238 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3239 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3240 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3241 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3242 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3243
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003244 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3245 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3246 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003247 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3248 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003249
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003250 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3251 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3252 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3253 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3254 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3255 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3256 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3257 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3258
3259 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3260 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3261 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003262 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3263 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003264
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003265 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3266 <name>.
3267
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003268 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3269 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3270 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3271 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3272 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3273 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3274 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3275 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3276
3277 Example:
3278
3279 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3280
3281 applied to:
3282
3283 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3284
3285 outputs:
3286
3287 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3288
3289 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3290
3291 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3292 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3293 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3294 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3295 header.
3296
3297 Example:
3298
3299 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3300
3301 applied to:
3302
3303 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3304
3305 outputs:
3306
3307 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3308
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003309 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3310 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3311 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3312 it.
3313
3314 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3315 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3316 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3317 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3318 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3319 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3320
3321 Example :
3322 # prepend the host name before the path
3323 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3324
3325 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3326 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3327 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3328 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3329 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3330 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3331 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3332 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3333
3334 Example :
3335 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3336 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3337
3338 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3339 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3340 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3341 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3342 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3343 "set-query".
3344
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003345 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3346 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3347 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3348 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3349 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3350 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3351 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3352 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3353
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003354 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3355 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3356 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3357 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3358 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3359 another equipment.
3360
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003361 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3362 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3363 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3364 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3365 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3366 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3367 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3368 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3369
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003370 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3371 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3372 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3373 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3374 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3375 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3376 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3377 admin privileges.
3378
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003379 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3380 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3381 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3382 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3383 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3384 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3385 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3386 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3387
3388 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3389 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3390 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3391 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3392 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3393 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3394
3395 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3396 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3397 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3398 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3399 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3400 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3401
3402 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3403 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3404 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3405 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3406 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3407 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3408 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3409 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3410 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3411
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003412 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3413 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3414 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3415 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3416 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3417 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3418 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3419 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3420 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3421 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3422 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3423 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3424
3425 These actions take one or two arguments :
3426 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3427 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3428 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3429 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3430
3431 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3432 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3433 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3434 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3435
3436 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3437 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3438 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3439 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3440 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3441 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3442 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3443 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3444
3445 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3446 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3447 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3448 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3449 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3450
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003451 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3452 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3453 function is documented in the API documentation.
3454
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003455 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3456
3457 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3458 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3459 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3460 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003461
3462 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003463 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3464 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3465 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003466
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003467 http-request allow if nagios
3468 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3469 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3470 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003471
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003472 Example:
3473 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003474 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003475
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003476 Example:
3477 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3478 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3479 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3480 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3481 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3482 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3483 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3484 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3485 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3486
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003487 Example:
3488 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3489 acl add path /addacl
3490 acl del path /delacl
3491
3492 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3493
3494 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3495 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3496
3497 Example:
3498 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3499 acl setmap path /setmap
3500 acl delmap path /delmap
3501
3502 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3503
3504 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3505 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3506
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003507 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3508 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003509
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003510http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003511 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003512 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3513 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003514 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3515 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3516 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3517 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003518 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3519 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003520 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003522 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3523
3524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3525 no | yes | yes | yes
3526
3527 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3528 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3529 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3530 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3531 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3532 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3533
3534 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3535 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3536 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3537 current section.
3538
3539 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3540 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3541 rules are evaluated.
3542
3543 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3544 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3545 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3546 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3547 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3548 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3549 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3550
3551 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3552 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3553 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3554 external users.
3555
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003556 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3557 <name>.
3558
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003559 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3560 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3561 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3562 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3563 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3564 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3565 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3566 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3567
3568 Example:
3569
3570 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3571
3572 applied to:
3573
3574 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3575
3576 outputs:
3577
3578 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3579
3580 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3581
3582 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3583 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3584 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3585 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3586 header.
3587
3588 Example:
3589
3590 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3591
3592 applied to:
3593
3594 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3595
3596 outputs:
3597
3598 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3599
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003600 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3601 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3602 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3603 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3604 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3605 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3606 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3607 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3608
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003609 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3610 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3611 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3612 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3613 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3614 another equipment.
3615
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003616 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3617 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3618 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3619 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3620 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3621 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3622 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3623 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3624
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003625 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3626 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3627 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3628 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3629 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3630 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3631 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3632 admin privileges.
3633
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003634 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3635 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3636 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3637 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3638 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3639 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3640 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3641 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3642
3643 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3644 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3645 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3646 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3647 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3648 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3649
3650 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3651 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3652 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3653 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3654 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3655 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3656
3657 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3658 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3659 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3660 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3661 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3662 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3663 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3664 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3665 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3666
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003667 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3668 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3669 function is documented in the API documentation.
3670
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003671 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3672
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003673 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003674 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3675 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3676 rules.
3677
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003678 Example:
3679 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3680
3681 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3682
3683 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3684 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3685
3686 Example:
3687 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3688
3689 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3690
3691 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3692 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3693
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003694 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3695 ACL usage.
3696
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003697
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003698http-send-name-header [<header>]
3699 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3700
3701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | no | yes | yes
3703
3704 Arguments :
3705
3706 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3707
3708 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3709 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3710 is added with the header string proved.
3711
3712 See also : "server"
3713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003714id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003715 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 no | yes | yes | yes
3718 Arguments : none
3719
3720 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3721 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3722 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003723
3724
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003725ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3726 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 no | yes | yes | yes
3729
3730 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3731 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3732 and running).
3733
3734 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3735 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3736 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003737 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003738 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3739
3740 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3741 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3742
3743 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3744 "unless" condition is met.
3745
3746 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3747
3748
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003749log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003750log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003751no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3754 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003755
3756 Prefix :
3757 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3758 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3759 prefix does not allow arguments.
3760
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003761 Arguments :
3762 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3763 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3764 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3765 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3766 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3767 parameter.
3768
3769 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3770 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3771
3772 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3773 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3774 standard syslog port).
3775
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003776 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3777 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3778 standard syslog port).
3779
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003780 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3781 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3782 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3783 appropriately writeable).
3784
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003785 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3786 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3787 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3788 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3789
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003790 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3791 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3792 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3793 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3794 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3795 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3796 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3797 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3798 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3799 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3800 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3801
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003802 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3803
3804 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3805 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3806 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3807
3808 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3809 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3810 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003811 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3812 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3813 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3814 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3815 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816
3817 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3818
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003819 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3820 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3821 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003822
3823 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3824 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3825 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3826 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3827
3828 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3829 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003830
3831 Example :
3832 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003833 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3834 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003835 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003837
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003838log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003839 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3840 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3841 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003842
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003843 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3844 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3845 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3846 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3847 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003848
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003849log-tag <string>
3850 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3852 yes | yes | yes | yes
3853
3854 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3855 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3856 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3857 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3858 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3859 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3860 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3861 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3862 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003864max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3865 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3867 yes | no | yes | yes
3868
3869 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3870 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3871 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3872 servers.
3873
3874 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3875 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3876 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3877 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3878 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3879 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3880 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3881 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3882 picking a different server.
3883
3884 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3885 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3886 even if they have to be queued.
3887
3888 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3889 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3890
3891
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003892maxconn <conns>
3893 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3895 yes | yes | yes | no
3896 Arguments :
3897 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3898 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3899 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3900 closes.
3901
3902 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3903 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3904 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3905 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3906 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3907 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3908 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3909 properly tuned.
3910
3911 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3912 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3913 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3914
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003915 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3916
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003917 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3918
3919
3920mode { tcp|http|health }
3921 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3923 yes | yes | yes | yes
3924 Arguments :
3925 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3926 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3927 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3928 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3929
3930 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3931 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3932 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3933 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3934 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3935
3936 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003937 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3938 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3939 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3940 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3941 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3942 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3943 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003944
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003945 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3946 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3947 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003948
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003949 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003950 defaults http_instances
3951 mode http
3952
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003953 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003955
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003956monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003957 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 Arguments :
3961 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3962 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003963 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003964 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3965 backend and its backup.
3966
3967 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3968 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3969 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3970 servers in a list of backends.
3971
3972 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3973 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3974 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3975 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3976 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3977 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3978 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003979 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3980 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003981
3982 Example:
3983 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003984 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003985 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3986 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3987 monitor-uri /site_alive
3988 monitor fail if site_dead
3989
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003990 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003991
3992
3993monitor-net <source>
3994 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | yes | yes | no
3997 Arguments :
3998 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3999 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4000 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4001 followed by a mask.
4002
4003 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4004 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004005 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004006 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4007
4008 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4009 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4010 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4011 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004012 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4013 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4014 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004015
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004016 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4017 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4018 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4019 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4020 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4021 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004022
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004023 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4024 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004026 Example :
4027 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4028 frontend www
4029 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4030
4031 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4032
4033
4034monitor-uri <uri>
4035 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | yes | yes | no
4038 Arguments :
4039 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4040 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4041
4042 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4043 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4044 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4045 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4046 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4047 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4048 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4049 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4050
4051 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4052 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4053 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4054 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4055 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4056 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4057
4058 Example :
4059 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4060 frontend www
4061 mode http
4062 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4063
4064 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004066
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004067option abortonclose
4068no option abortonclose
4069 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | no | yes | yes
4072 Arguments : none
4073
4074 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4075 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4076 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4077 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004078 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004079 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4080 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4081 encountered while delivering the response.
4082
4083 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4084 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4085 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4086 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4087 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4088 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004089 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004090 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004091 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004092 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4093 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4094 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4095
4096 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4097 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4098 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4099 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4100 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4101 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4102 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4103 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004104 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004105
4106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4108
4109 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4110
4111
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004112option accept-invalid-http-request
4113no option accept-invalid-http-request
4114 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4116 yes | yes | yes | no
4117 Arguments : none
4118
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004119 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004120 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4121 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4122 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4123 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4124 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4125 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4126 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004127 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4128 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4129 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4130 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4131 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004132 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004133 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4134 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4135 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004136
4137 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4138 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4139 been confirmed.
4140
4141 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4142 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004143 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4144 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004145 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4146
4147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4149
4150 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4151 stats socket.
4152
4153
4154option accept-invalid-http-response
4155no option accept-invalid-http-response
4156 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | no | yes | yes
4159 Arguments : none
4160
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004161 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004162 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4163 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4164 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4165 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4166 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4167 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4168 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004169 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4170 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4171 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004172
4173 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4174 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4175 been confirmed.
4176
4177 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4178 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4179 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4180 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4181
4182 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4183 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4184
4185 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4186 stats socket.
4187
4188
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004189option allbackups
4190no option allbackups
4191 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 yes | no | yes | yes
4194 Arguments : none
4195
4196 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4197 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4198 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4199 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4200 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4201 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4202 order between the backup servers anymore.
4203
4204 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4205 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4206
4207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4209
4210
4211option checkcache
4212no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004213 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 yes | no | yes | yes
4216 Arguments : none
4217
4218 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4219 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004220 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004221 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4222 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004223 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004224
4225 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004226 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004227 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004228 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4229 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004230 to the client are :
4231 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004232 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004233 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004234 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4235 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4236 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4237 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4238 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4239 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4240 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4241 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4242 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4243 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4244 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4245
4246 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004247 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004248 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004249 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004250 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4251
4252 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4253 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004254 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004255 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4256
4257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4259
4260
4261option clitcpka
4262no option clitcpka
4263 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4265 yes | yes | yes | no
4266 Arguments : none
4267
4268 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4269 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4270 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4271 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4272
4273 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4274 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4275 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4276 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4277
4278 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4279 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4280 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4281 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4282 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4283
4284 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4285
4286 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4287 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4288 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4289
4290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4292
4293 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4294
4295
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296option contstats
4297 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4299 yes | yes | yes | no
4300 Arguments : none
4301
4302 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4303 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4304 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4305 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4306 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4307 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4308 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4309
4310
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004311option dontlog-normal
4312no option dontlog-normal
4313 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4315 yes | yes | yes | no
4316 Arguments : none
4317
4318 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4319 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4320 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4321 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4322 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4323 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4324 logged.
4325
4326 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4327 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4328 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004330 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004331 logging.
4332
4333
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004334option dontlognull
4335no option dontlognull
4336 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4338 yes | yes | yes | no
4339 Arguments : none
4340
4341 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4342 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4343 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4344 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4345 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4346 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004347 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4348 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4349 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004350
4351 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4352 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4353 would not be logged.
4354
4355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4357
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004358 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4359 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004360
4361
4362option forceclose
4363no option forceclose
4364 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004366 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004367 Arguments : none
4368
4369 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4370 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4371 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4372 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4373 global session times in the logs.
4374
4375 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004376 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004377 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004378
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004379 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4380 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4381 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4382
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004383 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4384 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004385
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004386 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4387 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4388
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004389 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004390
4391
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004392option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004393 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | yes | yes | yes
4396 Arguments :
4397 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4398 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004399 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004400 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004401
4402 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4403 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4404 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4405 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4406 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4407 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4408 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004409 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4410 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4411 possible that the client has already brought one.
4412
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004413 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004414 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004415 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4416 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004417 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4418 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004419
4420 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4421 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4422 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4423 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4424 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4425 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4426 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4427
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004428 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4429 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4430 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4431 are under the control of the end-user.
4432
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004433 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004434 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4435 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004436 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4437 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4438 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004439
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004440 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004441 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4442 frontend www
4443 mode http
4444 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4445
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004446 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4447 backend www
4448 mode http
4449 option forwardfor header X-Client
4450
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004451 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004452 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004453
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004454
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004455option http-ignore-probes
4456no option http-ignore-probes
4457 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4459 yes | yes | yes | no
4460 Arguments : none
4461
4462 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4463 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4464 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4465 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4466 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4467 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4468 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4469 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4470 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4471 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4472 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4473 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4474
4475 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4476 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4477 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4478 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4479 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4480 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4481 are often the only way to detect them.
4482
4483 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4484 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4485
4486 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4487
4488
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004489option http-keep-alive
4490no option http-keep-alive
4491 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4493 yes | yes | yes | yes
4494 Arguments : none
4495
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004496 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4497 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4498 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4499 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4500 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4501 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4502 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4503
4504 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4505 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004506 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4507 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4508 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4509 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4510 situations where this option may be useful :
4511
4512 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4513 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4514
4515 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4516 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4517
4518 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4519 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4520 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4521 request.
4522
4523 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4524 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004525 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4526 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4527 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004528
4529 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4530 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4531
4532 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4533 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4534 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4535 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4536 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4537 not set.
4538
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004539 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4540 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004541 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004542 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004543
4544 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004545 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4546 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004547
4548
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004549option http-no-delay
4550no option http-no-delay
4551 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4553 yes | yes | yes | yes
4554 Arguments : none
4555
4556 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4557 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4558 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4559 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4560 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4561 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4562 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4563 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4564 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4565 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4566 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4567 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4568 affected.
4569
4570 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4571 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4572 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4573 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4574 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4575 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4576 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4577 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4578 latency environments.
4579
4580
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004581option http-pretend-keepalive
4582no option http-pretend-keepalive
4583 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4585 yes | yes | yes | yes
4586 Arguments : none
4587
4588 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4589 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4590 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4591 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4592 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4593 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4594 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4595 consider the response complete.
4596
4597 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4598 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4599 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4600 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4601 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4602 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4603
4604 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4605 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4606 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4607 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4608 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4609 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4610 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4611
4612 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4613 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004614 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004615 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4616 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004617
4618 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4619 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4620
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004621 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4622 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004623
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004624
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004625option http-server-close
4626no option http-server-close
4627 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4629 yes | yes | yes | yes
4630 Arguments : none
4631
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004632 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4633 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4634 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4635 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4636 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4637 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4638 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4639 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4640 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4641 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4642 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4643 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4644 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4645 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4646 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4647 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004648
4649 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4650 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4651 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4652 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004653 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4654 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004655
4656 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4657 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004658 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4659 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004660 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4661 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004662
4663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4665
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004666 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004667 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4668 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004669
4670
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004671option http-tunnel
4672no option http-tunnel
4673 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4675 yes | yes | yes | yes
4676 Arguments : none
4677
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004678 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4679 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4680 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4681 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4682 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4683 "option http-tunnel".
4684
4685 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004686 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004687 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4688 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4689 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4690 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4691 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4692 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4693 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004694
4695 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4696 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4697
4698 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4699 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4700 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4701
4702
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004703option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004704no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004705 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 yes | yes | yes | no
4708 Arguments : none
4709
4710 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4711 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4712 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4713 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4714 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4715 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4716 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4717
4718 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4719 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4720 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4721 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4722 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4723 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4724 request along its whole life.
4725
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004726 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4727 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4728 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4729 front of an existing proxy.
4730
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004731 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4732
4733 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4734 http-server-close".
4735
4736
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004737option httpchk
4738option httpchk <uri>
4739option httpchk <method> <uri>
4740option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4741 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4743 yes | no | yes | yes
4744 Arguments :
4745 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4746 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4747 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4748 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4749 ones.
4750
4751 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4752 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4753 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4754
4755 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4756 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4757 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4758 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4759 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4760
4761 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4762 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4763 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4764 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4765 the lack of any response.
4766
4767 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4768
4769 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4770 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4771 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4772
4773 Examples :
4774 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4775 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4776 backend https_relay
4777 mode tcp
4778 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4779 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4780
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004781 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4782 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4783 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004784
4785
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004786option httpclose
4787no option httpclose
4788 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 yes | yes | yes | yes
4791 Arguments : none
4792
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004793 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4794 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4795 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4796 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004797 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004798 "option http-tunnel".
4799
4800 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4801 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4802 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4803 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4804 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4805 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4806 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4807 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004808
4809 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004810 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004811 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4812 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4813 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4814 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4815 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004816
4817 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4818 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004819 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4820 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004821 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4822 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004823
4824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4826
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004827 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4828 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004829
4830
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004831option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004832 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004835 Arguments :
4836 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4837 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4838 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4839 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4840 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004841
4842 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4843 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4844 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4845 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4846 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4847 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4848 ports.
4849
4850 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4851
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004852 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4853 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004855 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004856
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004857
4858option http_proxy
4859no option http_proxy
4860 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4862 yes | yes | yes | yes
4863 Arguments : none
4864
4865 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4866 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4867 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4868 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4869 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4870
4871 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4872 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4873 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4874 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004875 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004876 be analyzed.
4877
4878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4880
4881 Example :
4882 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4883 backend direct_forward
4884 option httpclose
4885 option http_proxy
4886
4887 See also : "option httpclose"
4888
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004889
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004890option independent-streams
4891no option independent-streams
4892 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4894 yes | yes | yes | yes
4895 Arguments : none
4896
4897 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4898 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4899 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4900 receive data or not.
4901
4902 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4903 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4904 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4905 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4906 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4907 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4908 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4909 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4910 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4911 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4912 socket buffers.
4913
4914 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4915 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4916 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4917 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4918 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4919
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004920 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004921 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4922 deprecated.
4923
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004924 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004925
4926
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004927option ldap-check
4928 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4930 yes | no | yes | yes
4931 Arguments : none
4932
4933 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4934 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4935 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4936 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4937
4938 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4939 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4940
4941 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4942 configure it.
4943
4944 Example :
4945 option ldap-check
4946
4947 See also : "option httpchk"
4948
4949
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004950option external-check
4951 Use external processes for server health checks
4952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4953 yes | no | yes | yes
4954
4955 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4956 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4957 command".
4958
4959 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4960
4961 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4962
4963
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004964option log-health-checks
4965no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004966 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4968 yes | no | yes | yes
4969 Arguments : none
4970
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004971 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4972 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4973 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004974
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004975 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4976 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4977 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4978 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4979 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4980
4981 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4982 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004983
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004984 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4985 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4986 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004987
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004988
4989option log-separate-errors
4990no option log-separate-errors
4991 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4993 yes | yes | yes | no
4994 Arguments : none
4995
4996 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4997 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4998 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4999 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5000 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5001 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5002 provides very important information.
5003
5004 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5005 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5006 error logs.
5007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005008 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005009 logging.
5010
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005011
5012option logasap
5013no option logasap
5014 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5016 yes | yes | yes | no
5017 Arguments : none
5018
5019 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5020 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5021 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5022 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5023 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5024 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5025 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005026 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005027 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5028 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5029
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005030 Examples :
5031 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5032 mode http
5033 option httplog
5034 option logasap
5035 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5036
5037 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5038 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5039 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5040 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005042 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005043 logging.
5044
5045
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005046option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005047 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005050 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005051 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5052 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005053 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005054
5055 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5056 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5057 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5058 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5059 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5060 in the MySQL table, like this :
5061
5062 USE mysql;
5063 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5064 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5065
5066 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5067 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5068 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5069 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5070 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5071 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5072 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5073 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5074 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5075
5076 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5077 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005078
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005079 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005080
5081 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5082 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5083 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5084 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5085 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5086 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5087
5088 See also: "option httpchk"
5089
5090
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005091option nolinger
5092no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005093 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5095 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005096 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005097
5098 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5099 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5100 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5101 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5102 connections.
5103
5104 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5105 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5106 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5107 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5108 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5109 this too.
5110
5111 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5112 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5113 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5114
5115 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5116 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5117 for servers.
5118
5119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5121
5122
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005123option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5124 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | yes | yes | yes
5127 Arguments :
5128 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5129 matching <network>
5130 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5131 header name.
5132
5133 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5134 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5135 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5136 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5137 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5138 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5139 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5140 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5141 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5142 possible that the client has already brought one.
5143
5144 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5145 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5146 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5147 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5148 header and requires different one.
5149
5150 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5151 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5152 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5153 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5154 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5155 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5156 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5157
5158 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5159 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5160 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5161 both are defined.
5162
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005163 Examples :
5164 # Original Destination address
5165 frontend www
5166 mode http
5167 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5168
5169 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5170 backend www
5171 mode http
5172 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5173
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005174 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5175 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005176
5177
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005178option persist
5179no option persist
5180 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5182 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005183 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005184
5185 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5186 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5187 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5188 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5189 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5190 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5191 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5192 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5193 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5194 redirected to another valid server.
5195
5196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5198
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005199 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005200
5201
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005202option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5203 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5205 yes | no | yes | yes
5206 Arguments :
5207 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5208 PostgreSQL server.
5209
5210 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5211 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5212 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5213 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5214
5215 See also: "option httpchk"
5216
5217
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005218option prefer-last-server
5219no option prefer-last-server
5220 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | no | yes | yes
5223 Arguments : none
5224
5225 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5226 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5227 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5228 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5229 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5230 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5231 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5232 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5233 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005234 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5235 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5236 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5237 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5238 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5239 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5240 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005241
5242 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5243 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5244
5245 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5246
5247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005248option redispatch
5249no option redispatch
5250 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5252 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005253 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005254
5255 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5256 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5257 be able to access the service anymore.
5258
5259 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5260 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5261
5262 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5263 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5264 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005266 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5267 "redisp" keywords.
5268
5269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5271
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005272 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005273
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005274
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005275option redis-check
5276 Use redis health checks for server testing
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
5279 Arguments : none
5280
5281 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5282 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5283 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5284 find the "+PONG" response message.
5285
5286 Example :
5287 option redis-check
5288
5289 See also : "option httpchk"
5290
5291
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005292option smtpchk
5293option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5294 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005297 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005298 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5299 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5300 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5301
5302 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5303 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5304 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5305
5306 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5307 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5308 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5309 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5310 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5311 dead server.
5312
5313 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5314 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5315 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5316 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5317
5318 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5319 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5320 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5321 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5322 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5323
5324 Example :
5325 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5326
5327 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005330option socket-stats
5331no option socket-stats
5332
5333 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | yes | yes | no
5336
5337 Arguments : none
5338
5339
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005340option splice-auto
5341no option splice-auto
5342 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5344 yes | yes | yes | yes
5345 Arguments : none
5346
5347 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5348 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5349 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5350 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005351 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005352 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5353 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5354 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5355 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5356
5357 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5358 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5359 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5360 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5361 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5362 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5363 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5364 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5365 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5366 keyword.
5367
5368 Example :
5369 option splice-auto
5370
5371 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5372 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5373
5374 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5375 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5376
5377
5378option splice-request
5379no option splice-request
5380 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | yes | yes | yes
5383 Arguments : none
5384
5385 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005386 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005387 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5388 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5389 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5390 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5391
5392 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5393
5394 Example :
5395 option splice-request
5396
5397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5399
5400 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5401 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5402
5403
5404option splice-response
5405no option splice-response
5406 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5408 yes | yes | yes | yes
5409 Arguments : none
5410
5411 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005412 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005413 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5414 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5415 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5416 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5417
5418 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5419
5420 Example :
5421 option splice-response
5422
5423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5425
5426 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5427 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5428
5429
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005430option srvtcpka
5431no option srvtcpka
5432 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5434 yes | no | yes | yes
5435 Arguments : none
5436
5437 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5438 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5439 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5440 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5441
5442 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5443 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5444 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5445 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5446
5447 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5448 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5449 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5450 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5451 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5452
5453 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5454
5455 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5456 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5457 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5458
5459 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5460 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5461
5462 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5463
5464
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005465option ssl-hello-chk
5466 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5468 yes | no | yes | yes
5469 Arguments : none
5470
5471 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5472 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5473 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5474 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5475 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5476 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5477 hello message.
5478
5479 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5480 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5481 messages, which is appreciable.
5482
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005483 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5484 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5485 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005486
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005487 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5488
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005489
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005490option tcp-check
5491 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | no | yes | yes
5494
5495 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5496 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5497
5498 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5499 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5500 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5501
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005502 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005503 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5504 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5505 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5506 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5507 only.
5508
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005509 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005510 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5511 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5512 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5513 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5514
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005515 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005516 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5517 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005518 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005519 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5520 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5521 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5522 the respective protocols.
5523 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5524 analysed.
5525
5526 Examples :
5527 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5528 option tcp-check
5529 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5530
5531 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5532 option tcp-check
5533 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5534
5535 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5536 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005537 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005538 option tcp-check
5539 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5540 tcp-check expect +PONG
5541 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5542 tcp-check expect string role:master
5543 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5544 tcp-check expect string +OK
5545
5546 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5547 (send many headers before analyzing)
5548 option tcp-check
5549 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5550 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5551 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5552 tcp-check send \r\n
5553 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5554
5555
5556 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5557
5558
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005559option tcp-smart-accept
5560no option tcp-smart-accept
5561 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 yes | yes | yes | no
5564 Arguments : none
5565
5566 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5567 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5568 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5569 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5570 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5571 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5572
5573 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5574 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5575 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5576 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5577
5578 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5579 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5580 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5581 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5582
5583 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5584 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5585 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5586
5587 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5588 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5589 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5590
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005591 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5592
5593
5594option tcp-smart-connect
5595no option tcp-smart-connect
5596 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | no | yes | yes
5599 Arguments : none
5600
5601 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5602 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5603 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5604 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5605 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5606
5607 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5608 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5609 complex.
5610
5611 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5612 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5613 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5614
5615 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5616 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5617
5618 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5619
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005620
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005621option tcpka
5622 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | yes | yes | yes
5625 Arguments : none
5626
5627 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5628 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5629 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5630 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5631
5632 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5633 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5634 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5635 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5636
5637 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5638 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5639 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5640 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5641 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5642
5643 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5644
5645 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5646 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5647 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5648 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5649 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5650 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5651 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5652 backends.
5653
5654 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5655
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005656
5657option tcplog
5658 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5660 yes | yes | yes | yes
5661 Arguments : none
5662
5663 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5664 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5665 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5666 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5667 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5668 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5669 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5670 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5671
5672 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005674 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005675
5676
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005677option transparent
5678no option transparent
5679 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005681 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005682 Arguments : none
5683
5684 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5685 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5686 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5687 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5688 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5689 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5690 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5691 appropriate server.
5692
5693 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5694 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5695
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005696 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005697 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005698
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005699
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005700external-check command <command>
5701 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5703 yes | no | yes | yes
5704
5705 Arguments :
5706 <command> is the external command to run
5707
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005708 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5709
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005710 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005711
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005712 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5713 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5714 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5715 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5716 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5717 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005718
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005719 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5720
5721 Environment variables :
5722 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5723 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5724
5725 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5726
5727 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5728
5729 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5730 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5731 for a UNIX socket).
5732
5733 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5734
5735 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5736
5737 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5738
5739 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5740
5741 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5742
5743 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5744 socket).
5745
5746 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5747 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5748
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005749 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5750 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5751 failed.
5752
5753 Example :
5754 external-check command /bin/true
5755
5756 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5757
5758
5759external-check path <path>
5760 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5762 yes | no | yes | yes
5763
5764 Arguments :
5765 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5766
5767 The default path is "".
5768
5769 Example :
5770 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5771
5772 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5773 "external-check command"
5774
5775
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005776persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005777persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005778 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5780 yes | no | yes | yes
5781 Arguments :
5782 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005783 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5784 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005785
5786 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5787 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5788 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5789 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5790 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5791 forwarded to this server.
5792
5793 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5794 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5795 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005796 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005797 a single "listen" section.
5798
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005799 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5800 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5801 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5802
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005803 Example :
5804 listen tse-farm
5805 bind :3389
5806 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5807 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5808 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5809 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5810 persist rdp-cookie
5811 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005812 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005813 balance rdp-cookie
5814 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5815 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5816
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005817 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5818 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005819
5820
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005821rate-limit sessions <rate>
5822 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5824 yes | yes | yes | no
5825 Arguments :
5826 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5827 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5828
5829 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5830 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5831 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5832 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5833 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5834 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5835
5836 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5837 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5838 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5839 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5840
5841 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5842 listen smtp
5843 mode tcp
5844 bind :25
5845 rate-limit sessions 10
5846 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5847
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005848 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5849 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5850 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005851
5852 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5853
5854
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005855redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5856redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5857redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005858 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5860 no | yes | yes | yes
5861
5862 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005863 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005864
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005865 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005866 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005867 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5868 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5869 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005870
5871 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5872 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5873 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5874 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5875 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005876 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5877 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5878 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5879 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005880
5881 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5882 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5883 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5884 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5885 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5886 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005887 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005888 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005889 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5890 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5891 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005892
5893 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005894 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5895 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5896 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5897 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5898 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5899 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5900 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5901 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005902
5903 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5904 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5905
5906 - "drop-query"
5907 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5908 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5909 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5910 with a location-type redirect.
5911
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005912 - "append-slash"
5913 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5914 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5915 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5916 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5917
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005918 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5919 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5920 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5921 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5922 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5923 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5924 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5925
5926 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5927 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5928 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5929 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5930 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5931 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5932 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005933
5934 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5935 acl clear dst_port 80
5936 acl secure dst_port 8080
5937 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005938 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005939 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005940 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5941
5942 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005943 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5944 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5945 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005946 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005947
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005948 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5949 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5950 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5951
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005952 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005953 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005954
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005955 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5956 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5957 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005959 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005960
5961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005962redisp (deprecated)
5963redispatch (deprecated)
5964 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5966 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005967 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005968
5969 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5970 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5971 be able to access the service anymore.
5972
5973 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5974 redistribute them to a working server.
5975
5976 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5977 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5978 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005980 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5981 "option redispatch" instead.
5982
5983 See also : "option redispatch"
5984
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005985
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005986reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005987 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5989 no | yes | yes | yes
5990 Arguments :
5991 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5992 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005993 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005994
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005995 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5996 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5997
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005998 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5999 the last header of an HTTP request.
6000
6001 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6002 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6003 responses.
6004
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006005 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6006 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6007 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6008
6009 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6010 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006011
6012
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006013reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6014reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006015 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 no | yes | yes | yes
6018 Arguments :
6019 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6020 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6021 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6022 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6023 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6024 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6025 ignores case.
6026
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006027 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6028 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6029
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006030 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6031 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6032 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6033 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006034 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006035
6036 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6037 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6038
6039 Example :
6040 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6041 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6042 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6043
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006044 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6045 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006046
6047
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006048reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6049reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006050 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 no | yes | yes | yes
6053 Arguments :
6054 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6055 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6056 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6057 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6058 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6059 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6060
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006061 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6062 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6063
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006064 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6065 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6066 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6067 next servers.
6068
6069 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6070 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6071 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6072
6073 Example :
6074 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6075 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6076 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6077
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006078 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6079 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006080
6081
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006082reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6083reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006084 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6086 no | yes | yes | yes
6087 Arguments :
6088 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6089 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6090 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6091 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6092 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6093 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6094 case.
6095
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006096 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6097 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6098
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006099 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6100 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6101 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6102 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006103 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006104
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006105 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006106 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006107 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006108
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006109 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6110 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6111
6112 Example :
6113 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6114 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6115 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6116
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006117 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6118 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006119
6120
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006121reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6122reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006123 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 no | yes | yes | yes
6126 Arguments :
6127 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6128 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6129 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6130 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6131 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6132 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6133 case.
6134
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006135 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6136 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6137
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006138 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6139 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6140 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6141 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6142
6143 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6144 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6145
6146 Example :
6147 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6148 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6149 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6150 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6151
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006152 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6153 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006154
6155
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006156reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6157reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006158 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6160 no | yes | yes | yes
6161 Arguments :
6162 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6163 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6164 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6165 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6166 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6167 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6168
6169 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6170 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6171 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6172 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006173 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006174
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006175 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6176 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6177
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006178 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6179 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6180 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6181
6182 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6183 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6184 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6185 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6186 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6187
6188 Example :
6189 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006190 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006191 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6192 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6193
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006194 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6195 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006196
6197
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006198reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6199reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006200 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6202 no | yes | yes | yes
6203 Arguments :
6204 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6205 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6206 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6207 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6208 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6209 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6210 ignores case.
6211
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006212 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6213 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6214
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006215 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6216 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006217 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6218 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6219 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006220 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6221 not set.
6222
6223 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6224 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6225 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6226 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6227 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6228
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006229 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006230 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6231 # block all others.
6232 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6233 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006235 # block bad guys
6236 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6237 reqitarpit . if badguys
6238
6239 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6240 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006241
6242
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006243retries <value>
6244 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6246 yes | no | yes | yes
6247 Arguments :
6248 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6249 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6250 default value is 3.
6251
6252 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6253 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6254 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6255
6256 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6257 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6258
6259 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6260 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6261
6262 See also : "option redispatch"
6263
6264
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006265rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006266 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6268 no | yes | yes | yes
6269 Arguments :
6270 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6271 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006272 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006273
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006274 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6275 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6276
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006277 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6278 the last header of an HTTP response.
6279
6280 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6281 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6282 responses.
6283
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006284 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6285 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006286
6287
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006288rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6289rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006290 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6292 no | yes | yes | yes
6293 Arguments :
6294 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6295 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6296 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6297 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6298 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6299 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6300 ignores case.
6301
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006302 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6303 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6304
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006305 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6306 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006307 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006308 client.
6309
6310 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6311 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6312 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6313
6314 Example :
6315 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006316 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006317
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006318 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6319 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006320
6321
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006322rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6323rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006324 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6326 no | yes | yes | yes
6327 Arguments :
6328 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6329 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6330 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6331 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6332 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6333 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6334 ignores case.
6335
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006336 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6337 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6338
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006339 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6340 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6341 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6342 case-sensitive.
6343
6344 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006345 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6346 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6347 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006348
6349 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6350 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6351
6352 Example :
6353 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6354 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6355
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006356 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6357 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006358
6359
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006360rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6361rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006362 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6364 no | yes | yes | yes
6365 Arguments :
6366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6367 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6368 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6369 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6370 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6371 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6372 ignores case.
6373
6374 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6375 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6376 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6377 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006378 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006379
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006380 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6381 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6382
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006383 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6384 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6385 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6386
6387 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6388 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6389 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6390 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6391 are not case-sensitive.
6392
6393 Example :
6394 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6395 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6396
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006397 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6398 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006399
6400
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006401server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006402 Declare a server in a backend
6403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6404 no | no | yes | yes
6405 Arguments :
6406 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006407 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006408 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006409
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006410 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6411 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6412 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6413 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006414 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6415 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6416 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6417 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6418 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006419 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6420 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6421 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6422 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6423 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6424 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6425 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006426 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006427 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6428 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6429 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6430 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006432 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006433 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6434 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6435 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6436 adding this value to the client's port.
6437
6438 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6439 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006440 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006441
6442 Examples :
6443 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6444 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006445 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006446 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6447 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6448 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006449
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006450 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6451 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006452
6453
6454source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006455source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006456source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006457 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 yes | no | yes | yes
6460 Arguments :
6461 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6462 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006463
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006464 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006465 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6466 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6467 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6468 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6469 supported prefixes are :
6470 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6471 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6472 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006473 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006474 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6475 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6476 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6477 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006478
6479 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6480 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006481 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6482 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6483 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006484
6485 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6486 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6487 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6488 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6489 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6490 <addr>.
6491
6492 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6493 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6494 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6495 port.
6496
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006497 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6498 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6499 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6500 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006501 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006502 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6503 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6504 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6505 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6506 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6507 HTTP header.
6508
6509 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6510 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006511 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006512 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6513 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6514 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6515 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6516 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6517 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6518 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6519
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006520 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6521 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6522 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6523 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6524 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6525 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6526
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006527 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6528 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6529 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6530 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6531
6532 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6533 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6534 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6535 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6536 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6537 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6538
6539 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6540 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6541 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6542 there are two methods :
6543
6544 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6545 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6546 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6547 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6548 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6549 of the client ranges may be used.
6550
6551 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6552 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6553 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6554 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6555 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6556 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6557 same session.
6558
6559 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6560 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6561 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6562 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6563 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6564 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6565
6566 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6567 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6568 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006569 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006570
6571 Examples :
6572 backend private
6573 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6574 source 192.168.1.200
6575
6576 backend transparent_ssl1
6577 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6578 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6579
6580 backend transparent_ssl2
6581 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6582 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6583 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6584
6585 backend transparent_ssl3
6586 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6587 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6588 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6589
6590 backend transparent_smtp
6591 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6592 # with Tproxy version 4.
6593 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6594
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006595 backend transparent_http
6596 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6597 # proxy.
6598 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006600 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006601 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006603
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006604srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6605 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6607 yes | no | yes | yes
6608 Arguments :
6609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6611 as explained at the top of this document.
6612
6613 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6614 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6615 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6616 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6617 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6618 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6619 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6620
6621 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6622 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6623 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6624 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6625 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006626 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006627 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006628 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006629
6630 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6631 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6632 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6633 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6634 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6635 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6636
6637 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6638 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6639
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006640 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6641 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006642
6643
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006644stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6645 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006647 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006648
6649 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6650 matched.
6651
6652 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6653 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6654
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006655 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6656 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6657 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6658
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006659 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6660 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6661 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6662 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006663
6664 Example :
6665 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6666 backend stats_localhost
6667 stats enable
6668 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6669
6670 Example :
6671 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6672 backend stats_auth
6673 stats enable
6674 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6675 stats admin if TRUE
6676
6677 Example :
6678 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6679 userlist stats-auth
6680 group admin users admin
6681 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6682 group readonly users haproxy
6683 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6684
6685 backend stats_auth
6686 stats enable
6687 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6688 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6689 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6690 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6691
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006692 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6693 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6694 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006695
6696
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006697stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6698 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006700 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006701 Arguments :
6702 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6703
6704 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6705
6706 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6707 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6708 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6709 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6710 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6711 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6712
6713 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6714 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6715 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006716 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006717
6718 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6719 report using "stats scope".
6720
6721 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6722 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6723 unobvious parameters.
6724
6725 Example :
6726 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6727 backend public_www
6728 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6729 stats enable
6730 stats hide-version
6731 stats scope .
6732 stats uri /admin?stats
6733 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6734 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6735 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6736
6737 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6738 backend private_monitoring
6739 stats enable
6740 stats uri /admin?stats
6741 stats refresh 5s
6742
6743 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6744
6745
6746stats enable
6747 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006749 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006750 Arguments : none
6751
6752 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6753 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6754 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6755 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6756 - stats auth : no authentication
6757 - stats scope : no restriction
6758
6759 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6760 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6761 unobvious parameters.
6762
6763 Example :
6764 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6765 backend public_www
6766 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6767 stats enable
6768 stats hide-version
6769 stats scope .
6770 stats uri /admin?stats
6771 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6772 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6773 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6774
6775 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6776 backend private_monitoring
6777 stats enable
6778 stats uri /admin?stats
6779 stats refresh 5s
6780
6781 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6782
6783
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006784stats hide-version
6785 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006787 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006788 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006789
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006790 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6791 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6792 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6793 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6794 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6795 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006797 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6798 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6799 unobvious parameters.
6800
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006801 Example :
6802 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6803 backend public_www
6804 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006805 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006806 stats hide-version
6807 stats scope .
6808 stats uri /admin?stats
6809 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6810 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6811 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006812
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006813 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6814 backend private_monitoring
6815 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006816 stats uri /admin?stats
6817 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006818
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006819 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006820
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006821
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006822stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6823 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824 Access control for statistics
6825
6826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 no | no | yes | yes
6828
6829 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6830 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6831 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6832 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6833 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6834 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6835
6836 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6837 instance.
6838
6839 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6840 about ACL usage.
6841
6842
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006843stats realm <realm>
6844 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006846 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006847 Arguments :
6848 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6849 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6850 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6851
6852 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6853 using a backslash ('\').
6854
6855 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6856 only related to authentication.
6857
6858 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6859 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6860 unobvious parameters.
6861
6862 Example :
6863 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6864 backend public_www
6865 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6866 stats enable
6867 stats hide-version
6868 stats scope .
6869 stats uri /admin?stats
6870 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6871 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6872 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6873
6874 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6875 backend private_monitoring
6876 stats enable
6877 stats uri /admin?stats
6878 stats refresh 5s
6879
6880 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6881
6882
6883stats refresh <delay>
6884 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006886 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006887 Arguments :
6888 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6889 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6890 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6891 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6892 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6893 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6894
6895 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6896 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6897 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6898 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6899
6900 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6901 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6902 unobvious parameters.
6903
6904 Example :
6905 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6906 backend public_www
6907 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6908 stats enable
6909 stats hide-version
6910 stats scope .
6911 stats uri /admin?stats
6912 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6913 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6914 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6915
6916 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6917 backend private_monitoring
6918 stats enable
6919 stats uri /admin?stats
6920 stats refresh 5s
6921
6922 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6923
6924
6925stats scope { <name> | "." }
6926 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006928 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006929 Arguments :
6930 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6931 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6932 section in which the statement appears.
6933
6934 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6935 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6936 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6937 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6938 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6939 exists.
6940
6941 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6942 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6943 unobvious parameters.
6944
6945 Example :
6946 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6947 backend public_www
6948 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6949 stats enable
6950 stats hide-version
6951 stats scope .
6952 stats uri /admin?stats
6953 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6954 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6955 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6956
6957 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6958 backend private_monitoring
6959 stats enable
6960 stats uri /admin?stats
6961 stats refresh 5s
6962
6963 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6964
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006965
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006966stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006967 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006969 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006970
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006971 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006972 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6973
6974 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6975 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6976
6977 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6978 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006979 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006980
6981 Example :
6982 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6983 backend private_monitoring
6984 stats enable
6985 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6986 stats uri /admin?stats
6987 stats refresh 5s
6988
6989 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6990 global section.
6991
6992
6993stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006994 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6996 yes | yes | yes | yes
6997 Arguments : none
6998
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006999 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007000 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7001 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7002 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7003 - IP (socket, server)
7004 - cookie (backend, server)
7005
7006 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7007 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007008 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007009
7010 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7011
7012
7013stats show-node [ <name> ]
7014 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007016 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007017 Arguments:
7018 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7019 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7020
7021 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7022 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007023 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007024
7025 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7026 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7027 unobvious parameters.
7028
7029 Example:
7030 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7031 backend private_monitoring
7032 stats enable
7033 stats show-node Europe-1
7034 stats uri /admin?stats
7035 stats refresh 5s
7036
7037 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7038 section.
7039
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007040
7041stats uri <prefix>
7042 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007045 Arguments :
7046 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7047 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7048 query string.
7049
7050 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7051 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7052 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7053 possible to reach it in the application.
7054
7055 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007056 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007057 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7058 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7059 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7060 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7061
7062 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7063 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7064 an address or a port to statistics only.
7065
7066 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7067 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7068 unobvious parameters.
7069
7070 Example :
7071 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7072 backend public_www
7073 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7074 stats enable
7075 stats hide-version
7076 stats scope .
7077 stats uri /admin?stats
7078 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7079 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7080 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7081
7082 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7083 backend private_monitoring
7084 stats enable
7085 stats uri /admin?stats
7086 stats refresh 5s
7087
7088 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7089
7090
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007091stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7092 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007094 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007095
7096 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007097 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007098 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7099 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7100 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7101
7102 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7103 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7104 the "stick-table" statement.
7105
7106 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7107 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7108 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7109 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7110 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7111
7112 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7113 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7114 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7115 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7116 transformation rules.
7117
7118 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7119 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7120 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7121 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7122 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7123 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7124 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7125
7126 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7127 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7128 ACL based conditions.
7129
7130 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7131 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7132 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7133 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7134
7135 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7136 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7137 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7138 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7139
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007140 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7141 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7142 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7143
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007144 Example :
7145 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7146 # last 30 minutes
7147 backend pop
7148 mode tcp
7149 balance roundrobin
7150 stick store-request src
7151 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7152 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7153 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7154
7155 backend smtp
7156 mode tcp
7157 balance roundrobin
7158 stick match src table pop
7159 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7160 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7161
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007162 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007163 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007164
7165
7166stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7167 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7169 no | no | yes | yes
7170
7171 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7172 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7173 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7174 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7175
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007176 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7177 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7178 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7179
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007180 Examples :
7181 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007182 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007183
7184 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7185 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7186 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7187
7188
7189 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7190 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7191 backend http
7192 mode http
7193 balance roundrobin
7194 stick on src table https
7195 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7196 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7197 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7198
7199 backend https
7200 mode tcp
7201 balance roundrobin
7202 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7203 stick on src
7204 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7205 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7206
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007207 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007208
7209
7210stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7211 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 no | no | yes | yes
7214
7215 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007216 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007217 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7218 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7219 server is selected.
7220
7221 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7222 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7223 the "stick-table" statement.
7224
7225 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7226 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7227 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7228 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7229 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7230 address.
7231
7232 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7233 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7234 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7235 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7236 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7237 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7238 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7239 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7240 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7241 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7242
7243 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7244 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7245 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7246 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7247 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7248 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7249 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7250
7251 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7252 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7253 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7254 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7255
7256 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7257 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7258 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7259 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7260 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7261 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007262 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7263 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7264 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7265 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7266 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7267 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007268
7269 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7270 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7271 the request.
7272
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007273 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7274 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7275 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7276
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007277 Example :
7278 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7279 # last 30 minutes
7280 backend pop
7281 mode tcp
7282 balance roundrobin
7283 stick store-request src
7284 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7285 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7286 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7287
7288 backend smtp
7289 mode tcp
7290 balance roundrobin
7291 stick match src table pop
7292 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7293 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7294
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007295 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007296 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007297
7298
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007299stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007300 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7301 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007302 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007304 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007305
7306 Arguments :
7307 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7308 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7309 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7310 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7311
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007312 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7313 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7314 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7315 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7316
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007317 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7318 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7319 instance.
7320
7321 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7322 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7323 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7324 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7325 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7326 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007327 to 32 characters.
7328
7329 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7330 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7331 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007332 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007333 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7334 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007335
7336 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007337 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7338 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007339 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7340 increase.
7341
7342 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007343 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7344 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7345 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007346
7347 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7348 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7349 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7350 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7351 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7352 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7353 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7354 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7355 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7356 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7357 parameter (see below).
7358
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007359 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7360 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7361 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7362 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7363 soft restart.
7364
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007365 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7366 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007367
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007368 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7369 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7370 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7371 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7372 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007373 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007374 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7375 if not expiration delay is specified.
7376
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007377 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7378 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7379 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7380 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007381 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7382 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7383 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7384 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7385 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7386 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7387 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7388 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7389 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7390 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7391 types and their arguments.
7392
7393 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7394 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7395 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7396 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7397
7398 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7399 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7400 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7401 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7402
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007403 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7404 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7405 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7406 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7407 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7408 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7409
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007410 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7411 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7412 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7413 they were received.
7414
7415 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7416 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7417 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7418 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7419 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7420
7421 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7422 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7423 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7424 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7425 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7426
7427 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7428 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7429 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7430
7431 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7432 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7433 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7434 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7435 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7436
7437 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7438 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7439 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7440 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7441 the client side.
7442
7443 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7444 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7445 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7446 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7447 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7448 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7449 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7450
7451 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7452 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7453 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7454 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7455 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7456 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7457 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7458
7459 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7460 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7461 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7462 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7463 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7464 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7465
7466 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7467 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7468 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7469 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7470
7471 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7472 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7473 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7474 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7475 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7476 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7477 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7478 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7479 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7480 recommended for better fairness.
7481
7482 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7483 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7484 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7485 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7486
7487 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7488 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7489 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7490 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7491 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7492 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7493 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7494 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7495 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7496 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007497
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007498 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7499 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007500 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7501 reference it.
7502
7503 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7504 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7505 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7506 as an exclusive stickiness.
7507
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007508 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7509 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7510 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7511 something that can be ignored.
7512
7513 Example:
7514 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7515 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7516 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7517 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7518
7519 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007520 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007521
7522
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007523stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7524 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7526 no | no | yes | yes
7527
7528 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007529 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007530 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7531 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7532 server is selected.
7533
7534 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7535 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7536 the "stick-table" statement.
7537
7538 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7539 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7540 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7541 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7542
7543 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7544 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7545 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7546 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7547 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7548 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007549 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007550 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7551 rules.
7552
7553 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7554 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7555 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7556 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7557 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7558 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7559 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7560
7561 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7562 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7563 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7564 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7565
7566 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7567 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7568 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7569 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7570 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7571 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007572 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7573 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7574 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7575 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7576 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7577 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7578 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7579 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7580 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007581
7582 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7583
7584 Example :
7585 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7586 backend https
7587 mode tcp
7588 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007589 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007590 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007591
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007592 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7593 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7594
7595 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7596 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7597 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7598
7599 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7600 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007601
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007602 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7603 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7604 # at offset 44.
7605
7606 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7607 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7608
7609 # Learn on response if server hello.
7610 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007611
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007612 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7613 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7614
7615 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7616 extraction.
7617
7618
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007619tcp-check connect [params*]
7620 Opens a new connection
7621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7622 no | no | yes | yes
7623
7624 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7625 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7626 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7627
7628 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7629 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7630 of the sequence.
7631
7632 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7633 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7634 do.
7635
7636 Parameters :
7637 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7638 use the TCP connection.
7639
7640 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7641 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7642 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7643
7644 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7645
7646 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7647
7648 Examples:
7649 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7650 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7651 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7652 option tcp-check
7653 tcp-check connect
7654 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7655 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7656 tcp-check send \r\n
7657 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7658 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7659 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7660 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7661 tcp-check send \r\n
7662 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7663 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7664
7665 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7666 option tcp-check
7667 tcp-check connect port 110
7668 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7669 tcp-check connect port 143
7670 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7671 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7672
7673 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7674
7675
7676tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7677 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 no | no | yes | yes
7680
7681 Arguments :
7682 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7683 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7684 binary.
7685 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7686 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7687 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7688
7689 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7690 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7691 with the usual backslash ('\').
7692 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7693 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7694 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7695 used upper or lower case.
7696
7697
7698 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7699
7700 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7701 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7702 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7703 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7704 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7705 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7706 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7707 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7708
7709 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7710 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7711 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7712 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7713 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7714 expression.
7715
7716 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7717 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7718 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7719 this exact hexadecimal string.
7720 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7721
7722 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7723 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7724 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7725 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7726 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7727 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7728 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7729 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7730 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7731 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7732 the null character.
7733
7734 Examples :
7735 # perform a POP check
7736 option tcp-check
7737 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7738
7739 # perform an IMAP check
7740 option tcp-check
7741 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7742
7743 # look for the redis master server
7744 option tcp-check
7745 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7746 tcp-check expect +PONG
7747 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7748 tcp-check expect string role:master
7749 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7750 tcp-check expect string +OK
7751
7752
7753 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7754 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7755
7756
7757tcp-check send <data>
7758 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 no | no | yes | yes
7761
7762 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7763 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7764
7765 Examples :
7766 # look for the redis master server
7767 option tcp-check
7768 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7769 tcp-check expect string role:master
7770
7771 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7772 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7773
7774
7775tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7776 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7777 tcp health check
7778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 no | no | yes | yes
7780
7781 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7782 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7783 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7784 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7785 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7786 hexadecimal string.
7787 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7788
7789 Examples :
7790 # redis check in binary
7791 option tcp-check
7792 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7793 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7794
7795
7796 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7797 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7798
7799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007800tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7801 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7803 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007804 Arguments :
7805 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007806 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7807 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007808
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007809 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007810
7811 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7812 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007813 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7814 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7815 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7816 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7817 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7818 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007819
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007820 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7821 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7822 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7823 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007824
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007825 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007826 - accept :
7827 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7828 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7829 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007830
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007831 - reject :
7832 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7833 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7834 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7835 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7836 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7837 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7838 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7839 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7840 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7841 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7842 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7843 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007844
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007845 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7846 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7847 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7848 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7849 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7850 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7851 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7852 hosts.
7853
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007854 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7855 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7856 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7857 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7858 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7859 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7860 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7861 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7862 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7863 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7864 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7865
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007866 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007867 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007868 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007869 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007870 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7871 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007872 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007873 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7874 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7875 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7876 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7877 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007878
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007879 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007880 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007881 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007882 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7883 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7884 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7885 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007887 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7888 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7889 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7890 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007892 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7893 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7894 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7895 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7896 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007897 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7898 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7899 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7900 layer7 information is extracted.
7901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007902 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7903 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7904 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7905 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7906 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007908 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7909 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7910 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007911
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007912 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7913 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7914 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007916 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007917 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007918 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007919
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007920 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7921 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7922 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007924 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007925 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7926 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007927
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007928 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7929
7930 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7931
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007932 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007934 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007935
7936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007937tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7938 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007940 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007941 Arguments :
7942 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007943 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007944 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
7945 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007946
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007947 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007948
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007949 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7950 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7951 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7952 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7953 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007955 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7956 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7957 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7958 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007959 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7960 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7961 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7962 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7963 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7964 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007965 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007966 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007968 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7969 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7970 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7971 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007972
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007973 Four types of actions are supported :
7974 - accept : the request is accepted
7975 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7976 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007977 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007978
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007979 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7980 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007981
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007982 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7983 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7984 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7985 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7986 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7987 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007989 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007990 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7991 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007993 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007994 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7995 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7996 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7997 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007998 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7999 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8000 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008001
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008002 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008003 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8004 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8005 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008006
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008007 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8008 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8009 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8010 documentation.
8011
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008012 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008013 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8014 # and reject everything else.
8015 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8016 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008017 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008018 tcp-request content reject
8019
8020 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008021 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8022 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8023 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008024 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008025
8026 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8027 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8028 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008029 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008030 tcp-request content reject
8031
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008032 Example:
8033 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8034 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008035 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008036
8037 Example:
8038 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8039 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008040 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008042 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8043 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8044
8045 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008046 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008047 # protecting all our sites
8048 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008049 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8050 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008051 ...
8052 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8053
8054 backend http_dynamic
8055 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008056 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008057 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008058 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8059 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8060 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008061 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008065 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008066
8067
8068tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8069 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008071 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008072 Arguments :
8073 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8074 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8075 as explained at the top of this document.
8076
8077 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8078 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8079 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8080 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8081 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8082
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008083 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8084 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8085 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8086 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8087
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008088 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8089 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008090 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008091 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008092 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8093 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8094 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8095 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008096
8097 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8098 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8099 it pass through unaffected.
8100
8101 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8102 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8103 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008104 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008105 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8106 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008107 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8108 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8109 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008110
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008111 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008112 "timeout client".
8113
8114
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008115tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8116 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 no | no | yes | yes
8119 Arguments :
8120 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008121 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008122
8123 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8124
8125 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8126 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8127 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008128 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8129 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008130
8131 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8132
8133 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8134 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8135 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8136 inserted.
8137
8138 Two types of actions are supported :
8139 - accept :
8140 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8141 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8142 the rules evaluation.
8143
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008144 - close :
8145 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8146 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8147 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8148 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8149 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8150 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008151 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008152 protocols.
8153
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008154 - reject :
8155 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8156 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008157 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008158
8159 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8160 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8161 for changing the default action to a reject.
8162
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008163 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8164 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8165 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8166 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008167 period.
8168
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008169 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8170 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8171 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8172 documentation.
8173
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008174 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8175
8176 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8177
8178
8179tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8180 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8182 no | no | yes | yes
8183 Arguments :
8184 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8185 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8186 as explained at the top of this document.
8187
8188 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8189
8190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008191timeout check <timeout>
8192 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8193 established.
8194
8195 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8196 yes | no | yes | yes
8197 Arguments:
8198 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8199 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8200 as explained at the top of this document.
8201
8202 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8203 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8204 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8205 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008206 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8207 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8208 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008209
8210 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8211 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8212
8213 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8214 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008215 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008216
8217 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8218 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8219 forget about it.
8220
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008221 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8222 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008223
8224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008225timeout client <timeout>
8226timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8227 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8229 yes | yes | yes | no
8230 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008231 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008232 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8233 as explained at the top of this document.
8234
8235 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8236 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8237 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8238 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8239 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8240 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8241 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8242 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008243 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008244 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008245 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8246 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008247 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8248 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008249
8250 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8251 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8252 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8253 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8254 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8255 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8256
8257 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8258 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8259 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8260
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008261 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008262
8263
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008264timeout client-fin <timeout>
8265 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8267 yes | yes | yes | no
8268 Arguments :
8269 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8270 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8271 as explained at the top of this document.
8272
8273 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8274 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8275 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8276 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8277 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8278 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8279 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8280 down in one direction.
8281
8282 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8283 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8284 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8285
8286 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8287
8288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008289timeout connect <timeout>
8290timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8291 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 yes | no | yes | yes
8294 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8297 as explained at the top of this document.
8298
8299 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008300 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008301 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008302 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008303 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8304 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008305
8306 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8307 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8308 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8309 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8310 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8311 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8312
8313 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8314 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8315 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8316
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008317 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8318 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008319
8320
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008321timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8322 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8324 yes | yes | yes | yes
8325 Arguments :
8326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8328 as explained at the top of this document.
8329
8330 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8331 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8332 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8333 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8334 once the request has started to present itself.
8335
8336 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8337 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8338 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8339 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8340 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8341
8342 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8343 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8344 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8345 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8346
8347 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8348 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8349 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8350 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8351 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008352 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008353
8354 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8355 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8356 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8357 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8358
8359 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8360
8361
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008362timeout http-request <timeout>
8363 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008365 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008366 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8369 as explained at the top of this document.
8370
8371 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8372 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8373 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8374 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8375 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8376 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8377 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008378 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8379 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8380 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8381 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8382 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008383 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8384 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008385
8386 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8387 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008388 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8389 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008390
8391 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8392 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8393 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8394 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8395 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8396
8397 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008398 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8399 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8400 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008401
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008402 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8403 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008404
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008405
8406timeout queue <timeout>
8407 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8409 yes | no | yes | yes
8410 Arguments :
8411 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8412 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8413 as explained at the top of this document.
8414
8415 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8416 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8417 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8418 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8419 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8420
8421 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8422 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8423 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8424 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8425
8426 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8427
8428
8429timeout server <timeout>
8430timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8431 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | no | yes | yes
8434 Arguments :
8435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8437 as explained at the top of this document.
8438
8439 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8440 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8441 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8442 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8443 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8444 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8445 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8446
8447 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8448 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8449 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8450 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8451 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008452 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008453 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008454 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8455 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8456 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8457 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008458
8459 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8460 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8461 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8462 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8463 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8464 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8465
8466 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8467 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8468 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8469
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008470 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008471
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008472
8473timeout server-fin <timeout>
8474 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 yes | no | yes | yes
8477 Arguments :
8478 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8479 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8480 as explained at the top of this document.
8481
8482 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8483 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8484 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8485 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8486 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8487 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8488 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8489 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8490 situations, it should not be needed.
8491
8492 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8493 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8494 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8495
8496 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8497
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008498
8499timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008500 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8502 yes | yes | yes | yes
8503 Arguments :
8504 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8505 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8506 as explained at the top of this document.
8507
8508 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8509 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8510 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8511
8512 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8513 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8514 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8515 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008516 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008517
8518 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8519
8520
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008521timeout tunnel <timeout>
8522 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8524 yes | no | yes | yes
8525 Arguments :
8526 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8527 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8528 as explained at the top of this document.
8529
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008530 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008531 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8532 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8533 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8534 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8535 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8536 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8537 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8538 specified.
8539
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008540 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8541 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8542 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8543 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8544 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8545 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8546 state.
8547
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008548 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8549 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8550 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8551 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8552 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8553
8554 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8555 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8556 forget about it.
8557
8558 Example :
8559 defaults http
8560 option http-server-close
8561 timeout connect 5s
8562 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008563 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008564 timeout server 30s
8565 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8566
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008567 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008568
8569
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008570transparent (deprecated)
8571 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008573 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008574 Arguments : none
8575
8576 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8577 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8578 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8579 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8580 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8581 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8582 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8583 appropriate server.
8584
8585 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8586
8587 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8588 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8589
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008590 See also: "option transparent"
8591
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008592unique-id-format <string>
8593 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8595 yes | yes | yes | no
8596 Arguments :
8597 <string> is a log-format string.
8598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008599 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8600 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8601 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8602 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008603
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008604 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8605 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8606 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8607 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8608 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8609 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8610 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8611 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008612
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008613 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8614 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008615
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008616 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008617
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008618 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008619
8620 will generate:
8621
8622 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8623
8624 See also: "unique-id-header"
8625
8626unique-id-header <name>
8627 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8629 yes | yes | yes | no
8630 Arguments :
8631 <name> is the name of the header.
8632
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008633 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8634 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008635
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008636 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008637
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008638 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008639 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8640
8641 will generate:
8642
8643 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8644
8645 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008646
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008647use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008648 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8650 no | yes | yes | no
8651 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008652 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8653 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008654
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008655 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8656 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008657
8658 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8659 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8660 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008661 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8662 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8663 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8664 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008665
8666 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8667 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8668 assign the backend.
8669
8670 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8671 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8672 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8673 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8674 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8675 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8676
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008677 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008678 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008679 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8680 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8681 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8682
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008683 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8684 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8685 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8686 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8687 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8688 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8689 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8690 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8691 cannot be forced from the request.
8692
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008693 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008694 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8695 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8696
8697 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8698 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008699
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008700
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008701use-server <server> if <condition>
8702use-server <server> unless <condition>
8703 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8705 no | no | yes | yes
8706 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008707 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008708
8709 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8710
8711 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8712 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8713 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8714
8715 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8716 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8717 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8718 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8719 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8720 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8721 matches will assign the server.
8722
8723 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8724 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8725 with the next rules until one matches.
8726
8727 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8728 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8729 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8730 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8731
8732 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8733 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8734 stripped.
8735
8736 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8737 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8738 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8739 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8740
8741 Example :
8742 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8743 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8744 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8745 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8746 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8747 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8748 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8749 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8750 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8751
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008752 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008753
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008754
87555. Bind and Server options
8756--------------------------
8757
8758The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8759depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8760settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8761written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8762described in this section.
8763
8764
87655.1. Bind options
8766-----------------
8767
8768The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8769as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8770no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8771parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8772while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8773provided immediately after the setting name.
8774
8775The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8776
8777accept-proxy
8778 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008779 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8780 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008781 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8782 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8783 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8784 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8785 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8786 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8787 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008788 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8789 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008790
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008791alpn <protocols>
8792 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8793 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8794 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8795 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8796 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8797 initial NPN extension.
8798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008799backlog <backlog>
8800 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8801 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8802
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008803ecdhe <named curve>
8804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008805 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8806 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008807
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008808ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8810 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8811 client's certificate.
8812
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008813ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8815 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8816 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8817 error is ignored.
8818
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008819ciphers <ciphers>
8820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8821 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008822 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008823 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8824 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8825
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008826crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8828 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8829 to verify client's certificate.
8830
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008831crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8833 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8834 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8835 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8836 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8837 file.
8838
8839 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8840 are loaded.
8841
8842 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008843 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008844 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
8845 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8846 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
8847 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
8848 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
8849 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
8850 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008851
8852 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8853 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8854 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8855 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008856 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8857 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008858
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008859 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008860
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008861 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8862 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008863 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008864 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8865 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8866 clients).
8867
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008868 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8869 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8870 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8871 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8872 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8873 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8874 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8875 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8876 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8877 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8878 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8879 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8880 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8881
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008882 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
8883 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
8884 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
8885 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
8886 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
8887
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008888crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8890 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008891 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008892 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008893
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008894crt-list <file>
8895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008896 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8897 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008898
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008899 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008900
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008901 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8902 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8903 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8904 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8905 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8906 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8907 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8908 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008909
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008910defer-accept
8911 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8912 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8913 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8914 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8915 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8916 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8917 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8918 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8919 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8920 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8921 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8922
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008923force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008924 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008925 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008926 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8927 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008928
8929force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008930 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008931 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8932 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008933
8934force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008935 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008936 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8937 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008938
8939force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008940 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008941 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8942 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008944gid <gid>
8945 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8946 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8947 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8948 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8949 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8950
8951group <group>
8952 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8953 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8954 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8955 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8956 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8957
8958id <id>
8959 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8960 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8961 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8962 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8963
8964interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008965 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8966 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8967 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8968 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8969 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8970 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8971 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008972
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008973level <level>
8974 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8975 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8976 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8977 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8978 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8979 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8980 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8981 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8982 counters).
8983 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8984 all counters).
8985
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008986maxconn <maxconn>
8987 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8988 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8989 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8990 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8991 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8992 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8993 eat all memory.
8994
8995mode <mode>
8996 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8997 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8998 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8999 UNIX sockets.
9000
9001mss <maxseg>
9002 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9003 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9004 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9005 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9006 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9007 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9008 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9009 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9010 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9011 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9012 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9013
9014name <name>
9015 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9016 page.
9017
9018nice <nice>
9019 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9020 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9021 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9022 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9023 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9024 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9025 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9026 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9027 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9028 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9029 one for an RDP socket.
9030
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009031no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009033 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009034 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009035 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9036 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009037 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009038
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009039no-tls-tickets
9040 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9041 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9042 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009043 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9044 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009045
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009046no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009048 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009049 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009050 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9051 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9052 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009053
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009054no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009056 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009057 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009058 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9059 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9060 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009061
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009062no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009064 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009065 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009066 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9067 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9068 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009069
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009070npn <protocols>
9071 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9072 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9073 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9074 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009075 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9076 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009077
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009078process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9079 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9080 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9081 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9082 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9083 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9084 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9085 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009086 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9087 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9088 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9089 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9090 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9091 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9092 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009093
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009094ssl
9095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009096 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009097 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9098 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9099 to deciphered contents.
9100
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009101strict-sni
9102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9103 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9104 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9105 See the "crt" option for more information.
9106
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009107tcp-ut <delay>
9108 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9109 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9110 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9111 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9112 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9113 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9114 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9115 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9116 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9117 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9118 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9119
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009120tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009121 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009122 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9123 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9124 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9125 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9126 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9127 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9128 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009129 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9130 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9131 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009132
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009133tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9134 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9135 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9136 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9137 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9138 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9139 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9140 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9141 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9142 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9143 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9144
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009145transparent
9146 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9147 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9148 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9149 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9150 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9151 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9152 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9153 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9154 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9155 so check for support with your vendor.
9156
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009157v4v6
9158 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9159 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9160 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9161 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009162 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009163
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009164v6only
9165 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9166 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9167 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009168 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9169 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009170
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009171uid <uid>
9172 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9173 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9174 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9175 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9176 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9177
9178user <user>
9179 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9180 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9181 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9182 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9183 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9184
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009185verify [none|optional|required]
9186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9187 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9188 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9189 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9190 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009191 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9192 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9193 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9194 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009195
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020091965.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009197------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009199The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9200which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9201arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9202settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9203after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9204Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9205address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009207 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009208 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009210The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009211
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009212addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009213 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9214 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9215 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9216 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9217 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009219 Supported in default-server: No
9220
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009221agent-check
9222 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009223 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9224 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9225 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9226 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009227
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009228 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009229 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009230 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9231 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9232 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009233
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009234 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9235 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009236
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009237 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9238 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9239 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009240
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009241 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9242 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9243 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009244
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009245 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9246 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9247 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9248 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9249 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9250 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9251 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009252
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009253 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9254 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009255
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009256 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9257 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9258 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9259 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9260 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9261 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9262 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9263 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9264 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009265
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009266 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9267 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009268 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9269 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9270 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9271 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009272
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009273 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9274 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009275
9276 Supported in default-server: No
9277
9278agent-inter <delay>
9279 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9280 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9281
9282 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9283 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9284 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9285 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9286 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9287 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9288 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9289 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9290 of backends use the same servers.
9291
9292 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9293
9294 Supported in default-server: Yes
9295
9296agent-port <port>
9297 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9298
9299 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9300
9301 Supported in default-server: Yes
9302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009303backup
9304 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9305 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9306 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9307 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9308 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9309 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009311 Supported in default-server: No
9312
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009313ca-file <cafile>
9314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9315 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9316 server's certificate.
9317
9318 Supported in default-server: No
9319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009320check
9321 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009322 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9323 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9324 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9325 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9326 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9327 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9328 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009329 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9330 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9331 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009333 Supported in default-server: No
9334
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009335check-send-proxy
9336 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9337 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9338 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9339 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9340 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9341 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9342 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9343
9344 Supported in default-server: No
9345
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009346check-ssl
9347 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9348 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9349 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9350 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009351 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009352 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9353 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9354 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9355 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9356
9357 Supported in default-server: No
9358
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009359ciphers <ciphers>
9360 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009361 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009362 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9363 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9364 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9365 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9366 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9367 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9368
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009369 Supported in default-server: No
9370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009371cookie <value>
9372 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9373 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9374 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9375 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9376 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9377 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9378 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009380 Supported in default-server: No
9381
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009382crl-file <crlfile>
9383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9384 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9385 to verify server's certificate.
9386
9387 Supported in default-server: No
9388
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009389crt <cert>
9390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9391 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9392 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9393 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9394 certificate request.
9395
9396 Supported in default-server: No
9397
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009398disabled
9399 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9400 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9401 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9402 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9403 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9404
9405 Supported in default-server: No
9406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009407error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009408 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9409 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9410 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009412 Supported in default-server: Yes
9413
9414 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009416fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009417 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9418 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9419 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009421 Supported in default-server: Yes
9422
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009423force-sslv3
9424 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9425 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009426 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9427 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009428
9429 Supported in default-server: No
9430
9431force-tlsv10
9432 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009433 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9434 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009435
9436 Supported in default-server: No
9437
9438force-tlsv11
9439 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009440 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9441 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009442
9443 Supported in default-server: No
9444
9445force-tlsv12
9446 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009447 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9448 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009449
9450 Supported in default-server: No
9451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009452id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009453 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9454 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9455 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009457 Supported in default-server: No
9458
9459inter <delay>
9460fastinter <delay>
9461downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009462 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9463 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9464 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9465 between checks depending on the server state :
9466
9467 Server state | Interval used
9468 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9469 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9470 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9471 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9472 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9473 or yet unchecked. |
9474 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9475 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9476 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009478 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9479 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9480 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9481 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009482 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9483 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9484 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9485 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9486 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009488 Supported in default-server: Yes
9489
9490maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009491 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9492 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9493 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9494 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9495 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9496 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9497 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9498 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009500 Supported in default-server: Yes
9501
9502maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009503 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9504 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9505 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9506 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9507 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9508 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9509 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009511 Supported in default-server: Yes
9512
9513minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009514 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9515 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9516 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9517 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9518 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9519 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009520 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009521 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009523 Supported in default-server: Yes
9524
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009525no-ssl-reuse
9526 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9527 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9528 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9529 and for paranoid users.
9530
9531 Supported in default-server: No
9532
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009533no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009534 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9535 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009536 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009537
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009538 Supported in default-server: No
9539
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009540no-tls-tickets
9541 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9542 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9543 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009544 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9545 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009546
9547 Supported in default-server: No
9548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009549no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009550 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009551 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9552 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009553 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9554 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9555 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009556
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009557 Supported in default-server: No
9558
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009559no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009560 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009561 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9562 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009563 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9564 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9565 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009566
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009567 Supported in default-server: No
9568
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009569no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009570 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009571 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9572 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009573 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9574 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9575 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009576
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009577 Supported in default-server: No
9578
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009579non-stick
9580 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9581 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9582 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9583
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009584 Supported in default-server: No
9585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009586observe <mode>
9587 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9588 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9589 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9590 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9591 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9592 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009593 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009595 Supported in default-server: No
9596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009597 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009599on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009600 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9601 Currently, four modes are available:
9602 - fastinter: force fastinter
9603 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9604 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9605 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9606 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009608 Supported in default-server: Yes
9609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009610 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9611
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009612on-marked-down <action>
9613 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9614 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009615 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9616 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9617 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9618 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9619 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9620 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9621 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9622 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009623
9624 Actions are disabled by default
9625
9626 Supported in default-server: Yes
9627
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009628on-marked-up <action>
9629 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9630 Currently one action is available:
9631 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9632 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9633 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9634 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9635 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9636 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9637 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9638 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9639
9640 Actions are disabled by default
9641
9642 Supported in default-server: Yes
9643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009644port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009645 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9646 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9647 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9648 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9649 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9650 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009652 Supported in default-server: Yes
9653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009654redir <prefix>
9655 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9656 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9657 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9658 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9659 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9660 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9661 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9662 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009663 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009664 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9665 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9666 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9667 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9668 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9669
9670 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009672 Supported in default-server: No
9673
9674rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009675 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9676 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9677 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009679 Supported in default-server: Yes
9680
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009681send-proxy
9682 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9683 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9684 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9685 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9686 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9687 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9688 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9689 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9690 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009691 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9692 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9693 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9694 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9695 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009696
9697 Supported in default-server: No
9698
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009699send-proxy-v2
9700 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9701 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9702 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9703 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9704 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9705 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9706 option of the "bind" keyword.
9707
9708 Supported in default-server: No
9709
9710send-proxy-v2-ssl
9711 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9712 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9713 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9714 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9715 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9716 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9717 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9718 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9719
9720 Supported in default-server: No
9721
9722send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9723 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9724 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9725 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9726 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9727 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9728 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9729 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9730 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9731 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9732
9733 Supported in default-server: No
9734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009735slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009736 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9737 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9738 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9739 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9740 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9741 parameters :
9742
9743 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9744 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9745
9746 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9747 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9748 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9749 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9750
9751 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9752 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9753 seen as failed.
9754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009755 Supported in default-server: Yes
9756
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009757source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009758source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009759source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009760 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9761 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9762 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9763 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9764
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009765 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9766 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9767 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9768 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9769 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9770 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9771 server.
9772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009773 Supported in default-server: No
9774
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009775ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009776 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9777 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9778 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9779 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9780 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9781 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009782 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009783
9784 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009786track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009787 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9788 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9789 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9790 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009791 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009793 Supported in default-server: No
9794
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009795verify [none|required]
9796 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009797 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9798 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9799 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9800 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009801 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9802 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9803 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009804
9805 Supported in default-server: No
9806
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009807verifyhost <hostname>
9808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9809 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9810 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9811 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9812 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9813 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9814
9815 Supported in default-server: No
9816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009817weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009818 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9819 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9820 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009821 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9822 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9823 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9824 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9825 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9826 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009828 Supported in default-server: Yes
9829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009830
98316. HTTP header manipulation
9832---------------------------
9833
9834In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9835response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9836request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9837which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009838against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009839
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009840If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9841to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9842but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9843HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9844stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9845because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9846a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9847still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009849This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9850in section 4.2 :
9851
9852 - reqadd <string>
9853 - reqallow <search>
9854 - reqiallow <search>
9855 - reqdel <search>
9856 - reqidel <search>
9857 - reqdeny <search>
9858 - reqideny <search>
9859 - reqpass <search>
9860 - reqipass <search>
9861 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9862 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9863 - reqtarpit <search>
9864 - reqitarpit <search>
9865 - rspadd <string>
9866 - rspdel <search>
9867 - rspidel <search>
9868 - rspdeny <search>
9869 - rspideny <search>
9870 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9871 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9872
9873With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9874is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9875parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9876prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9877Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9878
9879 \t for a tab
9880 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9881 \n for a new line (LF)
9882 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9883 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9884 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9885 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9886 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9887
9888The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9889portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9890above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9891regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
98929 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9893is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9894
9895The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9896after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9897
9898Notes related to these keywords :
9899---------------------------------
9900 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9901 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9902 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9903
9904 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9905 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9906 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9907
9908 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9909 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9910 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9911 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9912 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9913
9914 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9915 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9916 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9917 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9918 useless headers before adding new ones.
9919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009920 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009921 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9922
9923 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9924 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9925 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9926
9927 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9928 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009929 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009930
9931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099327. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9933----------------------------------
9934
9935Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9936client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9937The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9938these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9939but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9940data called patterns.
9941
9942
99437.1. ACL basics
9944---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009945
9946The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9947content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9948from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9949simple :
9950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009951 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009952 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009953 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9954 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009956The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9957adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009958
9959In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009961 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009962
9963This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9964Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9965and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009966an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9967conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9968as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9969are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009970
9971ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9972'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9973which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9974
9975There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9976performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009978The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9979specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9980this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009981methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9982ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009983
9984Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9985 - boolean
9986 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9987 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9988 - string
9989 - data block
9990
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009991Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9992converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9993would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9994The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9995which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9996
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009997Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9998keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9999fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10000which are summarized in the table below :
10001
10002 +---------------------+-----------------+
10003 | Sample or converter | Default |
10004 | output type | matching method |
10005 +---------------------+-----------------+
10006 | boolean | bool |
10007 +---------------------+-----------------+
10008 | integer | int |
10009 +---------------------+-----------------+
10010 | ip | ip |
10011 +---------------------+-----------------+
10012 | string | str |
10013 +---------------------+-----------------+
10014 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10015 +---------------------+-----------------+
10016
10017Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10018matching method, see below.
10019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010020The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10021 - boolean
10022 - integer or integer range
10023 - IP address / network
10024 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10025 - regular expression
10026 - hex block
10027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010028The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10029
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010030 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10031 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010033 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010034 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010035 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010036 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010038The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10039read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10040if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10041lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10042will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10043beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10044a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10045lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10046exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10047
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010048The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10049parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10050ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10051a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10052check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10053
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010054The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10055socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10056file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010058Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10059loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10060
10061 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10062
10063In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10064the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10065case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10066as well.
10067
10068The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10069sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10070do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10071methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10072is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10073obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10074followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10075default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10076that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10077string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10078
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010079The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10080By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10081string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10082resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10083server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10084waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10085flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10086function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010088There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10089sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10090be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010091
10092 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10093 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010094 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10095 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10096 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10097 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010098
10099 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10100 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010101 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010102
10103 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010105
10106 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010107 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010108
10109 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10110 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10111
10112 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10113 binary or string samples.
10114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10116 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10119 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10120 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010122 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10123 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010125 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10126 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010128 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10129 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010131 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10132 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010133 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010135 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10136 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10137 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010138
10139For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10140request, it is possible to do :
10141
10142 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10143
10144In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10145buffer, one would use the following acl :
10146
10147 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10148
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010149On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10150possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10151
10152 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10155criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10156method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10157to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10158criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10159the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010162the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10163For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10166 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10167 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10168 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010169
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010170
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010171The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10172types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10173combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10174brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10175default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010177 +-------------------------------------------------+
10178 | Input sample type |
10179 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010180 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010181 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10182 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10183 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010184 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010185 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010186 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010187 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010188 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010189 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010190 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010191 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010192 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010193 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010194 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010195 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010196 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010197 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010198 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010199 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010200 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010201 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010202 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010204 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010205 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10206 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10207 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010208
10209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102107.1.1. Matching booleans
10211------------------------
10212
10213In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10214Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10215When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10216that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10217
10218Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10219return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10220"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10221
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102237.1.2. Matching integers
10224------------------------
10225
10226Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10227enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10228to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10229
10230Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10231matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10232lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010233
10234For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10235unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10236representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10237
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010238As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10239two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10240instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10241ranges and operators.
10242
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010243For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010244operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10245Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10246of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010248Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010249
10250 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10251 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10252 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10253 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10254 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010256For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010257
10258 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10259
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010260This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10261
10262 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10263
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102657.1.3. Matching strings
10266-----------------------
10267
10268String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10269different forms :
10270
10271 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10272 patterns ;
10273
10274 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10275 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10276
10277 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10278 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10279
10280 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10281 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10282
10283 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10284 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10285 matches.
10286
10287 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10288 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10289 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010290
10291String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10292exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10293characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10294string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10295to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010296before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010297
10298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102997.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10300---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010301
10302Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10303they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10304possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10305passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10306the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010307the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10308match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010309
10310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103117.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10312-------------------------------------
10313
10314It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10315not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10316a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10317to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10318digits may be used upper or lower case.
10319
10320Example :
10321 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10322 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10323
10324
103257.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10326---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010327
10328IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10329netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10330within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010331host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010332difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10333at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10334does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10335parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010336
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010337IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10338Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10339trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10340IPv6 patterns.
10341
10342HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10343following situations :
10344 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10345 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10346 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10347 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10348 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10349 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10350 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10351 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10352 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10353 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010355
103567.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10357----------------------------------
10358
10359Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10360combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10361
10362 - AND (implicit)
10363 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10364 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010366A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010370Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10371indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010373For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10374"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10375requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10376is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10377
10378 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10379 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10380 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10381 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10382
10383To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10384and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10385
10386 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10387 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10388 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10389 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10390
10391 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10392 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10393 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10394 use_backend www if host_www
10395
10396It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10397expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10398be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10399the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10400
10401 The following rule :
10402
10403 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10404 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10405
10406 Can also be written that way :
10407
10408 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10409
10410It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10411to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10412simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10413sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10414good use is the following :
10415
10416 With named ACLs :
10417
10418 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10419 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10420 monitor fail if site_dead
10421
10422 With anonymous ACLs :
10423
10424 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10425
10426See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10427
10428
104297.3. Fetching samples
10430---------------------
10431
10432Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10433against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10434sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10435ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10436of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10437available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10438
10439This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10440Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10441compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10442deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10443
10444The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10445matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10446method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10447indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10448
10449As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10450when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10451mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10452the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10453ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10454
10455Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10456multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10457when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10458incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10459are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10460is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10461all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10462
10463Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10464 - name
10465 - name(arg1)
10466 - name(arg1,arg2)
10467
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010468
104697.3.1. Converters
10470-----------------
10471
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010472Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10473of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10474is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10475was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10476has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10477unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10478
10479These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10480sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10481the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10482support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010483
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010484A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10485support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10486supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10487(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10488bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010490The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010491
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010492add(<value>)
10493 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10494 result as an unsigned integer.
10495
10496and(<value>)
10497 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10498 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10499
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010500base64
10501 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10502 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10503 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10504
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010505bool
10506 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10507 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10508 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10509 presence of a flag).
10510
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010511bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10512 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10513 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10514 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10515
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010516cpl
10517 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10518 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10519
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010520crc32([<avalanche>])
10521 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10522 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10523 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10524 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10525 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10526 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10527 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10528 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10529 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10530 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10531 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10532
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010533div(<value>)
10534 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10535 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10536 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10537
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010538djb2([<avalanche>])
10539 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10540 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10541 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10542 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10543 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10544 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10545 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010546 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10547 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010548
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010549even
10550 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10551 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10552
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010553field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10554 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10555 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10556 list of chars.
10557
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010558hex
10559 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10560 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10561 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10562 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010563
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010564http_date([<offset>])
10565 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10566 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10567 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10568 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10569 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10570 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010572in_table(<table>)
10573 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10574 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10575 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10576 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10577 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10578
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010579ipmask(<mask>)
10580 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10581 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10582 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10583 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10584
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010585json([<input-code>])
10586 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10587 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10588 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10589 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10590 of errors:
10591 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10592 bytes, ...)
10593 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10594 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10595
10596 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10597 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10598 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10599 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10600 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10601 are :
10602 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10603 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10604 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10605 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10606 error ;
10607 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10608 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10609
10610 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10611 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10612
10613 Example:
10614 capture request header user-agent len 150
10615 capture request header Host len 15
10616 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10617
10618 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10619 GET / HTTP/1.0
10620 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10621
10622 Output log:
10623 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010625language(<value>[,<default>])
10626 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10627 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10628 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10629 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10630 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10631 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10632 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10633 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10634 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10635 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10636 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10637 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010639 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010640
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010641 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10642 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010643
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010644 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10645 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10646 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10647 use_backend spanish if es
10648 use_backend french if fr
10649 use_backend english if en
10650 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010651
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010652lower
10653 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10654 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10655 type. The result is of type string.
10656
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010657ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10658 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10659 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10660 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10661 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10662 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10663 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10664
10665 Example :
10666
10667 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10668 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10669 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010671map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10672map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10673map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10674 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10675 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10676 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10677 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10678 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10679 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10680 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10681 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010683 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10684 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10685 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010686
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010687 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10688 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010689
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010690 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10691 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10692 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10693 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010694 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10695 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010696 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10697 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10698 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10699 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10700 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10701 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10702 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10703 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10704 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10705 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10706 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10707 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10708 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10709 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010710
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010711 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10712 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10713 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10714 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10715 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010716
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010717 Example :
10718
10719 # this is a comment and is ignored
10720 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10721 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10722 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10723 | | | `---------- value
10724 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10725 | `---------------------------- key
10726 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10727
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010728mod(<value>)
10729 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10730 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10731
10732mul(<value>)
10733 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10734 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10735 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10736
10737neg
10738 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10739 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10740 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10741 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10742
10743not
10744 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10745 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10746 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10747 absence of a flag).
10748
10749odd
10750 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10751 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10752
10753or(<value>)
10754 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10755 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10756
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010757regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010758 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10759 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10760 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10761 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10762 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10763 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10764 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10765 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10766 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10767 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10768 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10769 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10770 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10771
10772 Example :
10773
10774 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10775 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10776 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10777 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10778
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010779sdbm([<avalanche>])
10780 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10781 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10782 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10783 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10784 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10785 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10786 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010787 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10788 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010789
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010790sub(<value>)
10791 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10792 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10793 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10794
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010795table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10796 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10797 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10798 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10799 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10800 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10801 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10802
10803
10804table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10805 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10806 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10807 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10808 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10809 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10810 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10811
10812table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10813 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10814 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10815 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10816 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10817 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10818
10819table_conn_cur(<table>)
10820 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10821 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10822 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10823 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10824 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10825
10826table_conn_rate(<table>)
10827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10829 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10830 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10831 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10832
10833table_gpc0(<table>)
10834 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10835 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10836 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10837 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10838 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10839
10840table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10843 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10844 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10845 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10846 sample fetch keyword.
10847
10848table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10852 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10853 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10854
10855table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10858 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10859 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10860 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10861 keyword.
10862
10863table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10864 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10865 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10866 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10867 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10868 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10869
10870table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10873 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10874 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10875 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10876 keyword.
10877
10878table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10879 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10880 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10881 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10882 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10883 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10884 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10885 keyword.
10886
10887table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10891 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10892 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10893 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10894 keyword.
10895
10896table_server_id(<table>)
10897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10900 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10901 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10902 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10903
10904table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10908 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10909 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10910 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10911 keyword.
10912
10913table_sess_rate(<table>)
10914 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10915 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10916 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10917 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10918 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10919 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10920 keyword.
10921
10922table_trackers(<table>)
10923 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10924 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10925 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10926 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10927 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10928 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10929 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10930 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10931 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10932 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10933
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010934upper
10935 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10936 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10937 type. The result is of type string.
10938
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010939utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10940 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10941 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10942 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10943 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10944 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10945 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10946
10947 Example :
10948
10949 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10950 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10951 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10952
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010953word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10954 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10955 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10956
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010957wt6([<avalanche>])
10958 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10959 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10960 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10961 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10962 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10963 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10964 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010965 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10966 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010967
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010968xor(<value>)
10969 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10970 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10971
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010972
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010974--------------------------------------------
10975
10976A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10977not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10978"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10979The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10980
10981always_false : boolean
10982 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10983 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10984
10985always_true : boolean
10986 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10987 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10988
10989avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010990 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010991 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10992 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10993 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10994 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10995 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10996 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10997 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10998 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10999 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11000 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11001 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11002 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11003 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011005be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011006 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11007 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11008 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11009 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11010 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011012be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11013 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11014 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11015 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11016 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11017 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11018 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011019
11020 Example :
11021 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11022 backend dynamic
11023 mode http
11024 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11025 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011027connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011029 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011030 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11031 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011032
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011033 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011034 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011035 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11036
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011037 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11038 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011039
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011040 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011041 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011042 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011043 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11044 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011045 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011046 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011047
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011048 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11049 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011051 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011052
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011053date([<offset>]) : integer
11054 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11055 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11056 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11057 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011058 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11059
11060 Example :
11061
11062 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11063 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011064
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011065env(<name>) : string
11066 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11067 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11068 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11069 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11070 certain way.
11071
11072 Examples :
11073 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11074 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11075
11076 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11077 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011079fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11080 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011081 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11082 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11084 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11085 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11086 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11087 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11090 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11091 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11092 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11093 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11094 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11095 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11096 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11097 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011098
11099 Example :
11100 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11101 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11102 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11103 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11104 frontend mail
11105 bind :25
11106 mode tcp
11107 maxconn 100
11108 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11109 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11110 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11111 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011112
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011113nbproc : integer
11114 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11115 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11116 and debugging purposes.
11117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011118nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11119 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11120 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11121 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011122 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11123 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11124 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011125
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011126proc : integer
11127 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11128 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11129 debugging purposes.
11130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011131queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011132 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11133 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11134 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011135 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11136 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11137 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11138 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11139 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11140
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011141rand([<range>]) : integer
11142 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11143 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11144 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11145 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11146 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011148srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11149 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11150 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11151 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11152 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11153 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11154 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11155 methods.
11156
11157srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11158 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11159 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11160 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11161 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11162 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11163 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11164 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11165
11166srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11167 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11168 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011169 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11171 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11172 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11173 overloading servers).
11174
11175 Example :
11176 # Redirect to a separate back
11177 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11178 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11179 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11180
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011181stopping : boolean
11182 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11183 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11184 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011186table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11187 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11188 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11189
11190table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11191 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11192 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11193 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11194
11195
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111967.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011197----------------------------------
11198
11199The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11200closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11201methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11202sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11203TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011204the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11205counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11206"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011207argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11208the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11209this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011210
11211be_id : integer
11212 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11213 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11214
11215dst : ip
11216 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11217 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11218 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11219 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11220 RFC 4291.
11221
11222dst_conn : integer
11223 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11224 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11225 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11226 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11227 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11228 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11229 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11230 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011232dst_port : integer
11233 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11234 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11235 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11236 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11237 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11238 an HTTP header.
11239
11240fe_id : integer
11241 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11242 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11243 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11244
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011245sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011246sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11247sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11248sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011249 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11250 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11251 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11252
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011253sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011254sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11255sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11256sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011257 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11258 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11259 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11260
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011261sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011262sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11263sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11264sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011265 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11266 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011267 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11268 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11269 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011270
11271 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11272 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011273 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11274 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11275 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011276 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11277 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11278
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011279sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011280sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11281sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11282sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011283 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11284 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11285
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011286sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011287sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11288sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11289sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011290 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11291 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11292 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11293
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011294sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011295sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11296sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11297sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011298 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11299 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11300 See also src_conn_rate.
11301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011302sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011303sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11304sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11305sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011306 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011307 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011309sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011310sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11311sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11312sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011313 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11314 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11315 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011316 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11317 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11318 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011320sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011321sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11322sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11323sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011324 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11325 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11326 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011328sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011329sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11330sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11331sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011332 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11333 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11334 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11335 src_http_err_rate.
11336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011337sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011338sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11339sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11340sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011341 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11342 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11343 src_http_req_cnt.
11344
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011345sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011346sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11347sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11348sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011349 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11350 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11351 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11352 src_http_req_rate.
11353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011354sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011355sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11356sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11357sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011358 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011359 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11360 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11361 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11362 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011363
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011364 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11365 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011366 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011368sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011369sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11370sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11371sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011372 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11373 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11374 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011376sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011377sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11378sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11379sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011380 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11381 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11382 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011384sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011385sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11386sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11387sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011388 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11389 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11390 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11391 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011392 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011393 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11394
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011395sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011396sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11397sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11398sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011399 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11400 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11401 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11402 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11403 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011404 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011405
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011406sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011407sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11408sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11409sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011410 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11411 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11412 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11413
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011414sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011415sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11416sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11417sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011418 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11419 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011420 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011421 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11422 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11424 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11425 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011427so_id : integer
11428 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11429 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11430 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011432src : ip
11433 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11434 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11435 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11436 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11437 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11438 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11439 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011440
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011441 Example:
11442 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11443 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11446 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11447 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11448 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011449 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011451src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11452 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11453 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011454 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011455 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011457src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11458 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11459 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11460 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11461 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11462 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11463 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011464
11465 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11466 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11467 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11468 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011469 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011470 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11471 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011473src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011474 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011475 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011476 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011477 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011479src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011480 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11482 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011483 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011485src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11486 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11487 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11488 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011489 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011491src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011492 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011494 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011495 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011498 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011500 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11501 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011502 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11503 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11504 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011506src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11507 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11508 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011509 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011510 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11514 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11515 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11516 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11517 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011518 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011520src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11521 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11522 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11523 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011524 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011526src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11527 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11528 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11529 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011530 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011531 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011533src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11534 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11535 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11536 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011537 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11539 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011540
11541 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011542 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011543 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011545src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011546 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11547 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11548 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11549 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11550 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011552src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011553 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11554 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11555 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11556 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11557 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011559src_port : integer
11560 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11561 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11562 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11563 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11566 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011567 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11568 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11569 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011570 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011572src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11573 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11574 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11575 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11576 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011577 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011579src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11580 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11581 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11582 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11583 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11584 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11585 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11586 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11587 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011588
11589 Example :
11590 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11591 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11592 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11593 listen ssh
11594 bind :22
11595 mode tcp
11596 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011597 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011598 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011599 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011601srv_id : integer
11602 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11603 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11604 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011605
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116077.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011608----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011610The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11611closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11612when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11613usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011614future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011615
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011616ssl_bc : boolean
11617 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11618 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11619 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11620
11621ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11622 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11623 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11624
11625ssl_bc_cipher : string
11626 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11627 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11628
11629ssl_bc_protocol : string
11630 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11631 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11632
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011633ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011634 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011635 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11636 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011637
11638ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11639 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11640 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11641 if session was reused or not.
11642
11643ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11644 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11645 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011647ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11648 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11649 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11650 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11651 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11652 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011654ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11655 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11656 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11657 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11658 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011659
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011660ssl_c_der : binary
11661 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11662 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11663 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665ssl_c_err : integer
11666 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11667 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11668 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11669 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11670 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11673 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11674 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11675 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11676 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11677 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11678 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11679 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11680 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682ssl_c_key_alg : string
11683 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11684 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11685 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011687ssl_c_notafter : string
11688 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11689 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11690 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692ssl_c_notbefore : string
11693 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11694 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11695 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011697ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11698 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11699 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11700 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11701 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11702 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11703 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11704 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11705 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011707ssl_c_serial : binary
11708 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11709 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11710 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011712ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11713 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11714 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11715 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011716 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11717 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11718
11719 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011721ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11722 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11723 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11724 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011726ssl_c_used : boolean
11727 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11728 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011730ssl_c_verify : integer
11731 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11732 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11733 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11734 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011736ssl_c_version : integer
11737 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11738 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011739
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011740ssl_f_der : binary
11741 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11742 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11743 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011745ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11746 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11747 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11748 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11749 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011750 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011751 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11752 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11753 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011755ssl_f_key_alg : string
11756 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11757 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11758 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011760ssl_f_notafter : string
11761 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11762 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11763 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011765ssl_f_notbefore : string
11766 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11767 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11768 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011770ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11771 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11772 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11773 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11774 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11775 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11776 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11777 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11778 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011780ssl_f_serial : binary
11781 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11782 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11783 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011784
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011785ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11786 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11787 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11788 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011790ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11791 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11792 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11793 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011795ssl_f_version : integer
11796 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11797 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11798
11799ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011800 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11801 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11802 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011804 Example :
11805 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11806 listen http-https
11807 bind :80
11808 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11809 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11810
11811ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11812 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11813 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11814
11815ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011816 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11818 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11819 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11820 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11821 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11822 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11823 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11824 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011826ssl_fc_cipher : string
11827 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11828 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011830ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011831 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11832 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011833 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11834 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11835 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11836 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11839 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011840 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11841 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11842 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11843 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011846 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11848 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11849 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11850 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11851 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11852 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11853 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011855ssl_fc_protocol : string
11856 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11857 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011858
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011859ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011860 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011861 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11862 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011864ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11865 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11866 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11867 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11868 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011870ssl_fc_sni : string
11871 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11872 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11873 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11874 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11875 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11876
11877 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11878 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11879 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011880 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11881 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011883 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011884 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11885 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011887ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11888 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11889 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011890
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011891
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200118927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011895Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11896sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11897only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11898For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11899be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11900can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11901sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11902for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11903content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011905payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11906 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11907 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11908 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11911 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11912 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11913 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011915req.len : integer
11916req_len : integer (deprecated)
11917 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11918 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11919 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11920 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11921 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11922 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11923 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11924 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011926req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11927 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011928 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11929 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11930 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11931 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011933 ACL alternatives :
11934 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011936req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11937 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11938 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11939 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11940 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011942 ACL alternatives :
11943 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011945 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011947req.proto_http : boolean
11948req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11949 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11950 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11951 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11952 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11953 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11954 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11955 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011957 Example:
11958 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11959 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11960 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011961 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011963req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11964rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11965 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11966 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11967 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11968 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11969 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11970 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11971 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011973 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11974 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11975 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11976 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11977 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11978 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011980 ACL derivatives :
11981 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011983 Example :
11984 listen tse-farm
11985 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11986 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11987 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11988 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11989 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11990 persist rdp-cookie
11991 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11992 # This is only useful makes sense if
11993 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11994 stick-table type string size 204800
11995 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11996 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11997 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12000 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12003rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12004 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12005 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12006 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12007 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012009 ACL derivatives :
12010 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012012req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12013req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12014 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12015 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12016 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12017 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12018 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12019 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12020 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012022req.ssl_sni : string
12023req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12024 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12025 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12026 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12027 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12028 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12029 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12030 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12031 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12032 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12033 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12034 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12035 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012037 ACL derivatives :
12038 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012040 Examples :
12041 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12042 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12043 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12044 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12045 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012047res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12048rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12049 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12050 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12051 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12052 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12053 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12054 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12055 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012057req.ssl_ver : integer
12058req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12059 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12060 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12061 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12062 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12063 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12064 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12065 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12066 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12067 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012069 ACL derivatives :
12070 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012071
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012072res.len : integer
12073 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12074 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12075 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12076 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12077 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12078 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12079 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12080 content inspection.
12081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012082res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12083 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012084 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12085 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12086 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12087 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012089res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12090 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12091 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12092 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12093 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012095 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012097wait_end : boolean
12098 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12099 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12100 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12101 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12102 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12103 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12104 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12105 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107 Examples :
12108 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12109 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12110 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012112 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12113 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12114 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12115 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12116 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12117 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12118 tcp-request content reject
12119
12120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200121217.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012122--------------------------------------
12123
12124It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12125This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12126data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12127its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12128HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12129content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12130to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12131more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12132response are indexed.
12133
12134base : string
12135 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12136 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12137 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12138 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12139 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12140 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12141 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12142 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12143
12144 ACL derivatives :
12145 base : exact string match
12146 base_beg : prefix match
12147 base_dir : subdir match
12148 base_dom : domain match
12149 base_end : suffix match
12150 base_len : length match
12151 base_reg : regex match
12152 base_sub : substring match
12153
12154base32 : integer
12155 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12156 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12157 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012158 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12159 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12160 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012161
12162base32+src : binary
12163 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12164 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12165 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12166 per-URL counters.
12167
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012168capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12169 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12170 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12171 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12172
12173capture.req.method : string
12174 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12175 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12176 because it's allocated.
12177
12178capture.req.uri : string
12179 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12180 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12181 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12182 allocated.
12183
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012184capture.req.ver : string
12185 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12186 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12187 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12188
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012189capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12190 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12191 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12192 The first entry is an index of 0.
12193 See also: "capture response header"
12194
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012195capture.res.ver : string
12196 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12197 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12198 persistent flag.
12199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012200req.cook([<name>]) : string
12201cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12202 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12203 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12204 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12205 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12206 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12207 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12208 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12209 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12210
12211 ACL derivatives :
12212 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12213 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12214 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12215 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12216 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12217 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12218 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12219 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012221req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12222cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12223 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12224 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012226req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12227cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12228 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12229 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12230 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12231 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012233cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12234 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12235 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12236 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12237 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12238 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12239 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12240 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12241 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12242 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12243 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012245hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12246 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12247 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12248 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12249 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012250 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12253 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12254 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12255 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12256 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12257 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12258 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12259 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12260 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012262req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12263 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12264 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12265 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12266 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12269 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12270 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12271 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12272 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12273 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12274 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12275 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12276 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12277 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12278 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12279 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012281 ACL derivatives :
12282 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12283 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12284 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12285 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12286 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12287 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12288 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12289 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12290
12291req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12292hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12293 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12294 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12295 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12296 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12297 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12298 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12299 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12300 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12301 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12302
12303req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12304hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12305 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12306 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12307 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12308 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12309 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12310 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12311 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12312 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12313
12314req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12315hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12316 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12317 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12318 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12319 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12320 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12321 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12322 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12323
12324http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12325 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12326 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12327 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12328 basic auth is supported.
12329
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012330http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12331 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12332 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12333 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12334 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012335 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12336 basic auth is supported.
12337
12338 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012339 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12340 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12341 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12342 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012343
12344http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012345 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12346 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12348 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012350method : integer + string
12351 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12352 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12353 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12354 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12355 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12356 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12357 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012359 ACL derivatives :
12360 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012362 Example :
12363 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12364 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12365 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012367path : string
12368 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12369 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12370 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12371 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12372 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12373 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12374 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012376 ACL derivatives :
12377 path : exact string match
12378 path_beg : prefix match
12379 path_dir : subdir match
12380 path_dom : domain match
12381 path_end : suffix match
12382 path_len : length match
12383 path_reg : regex match
12384 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012385
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012386query : string
12387 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12388 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12389 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12390 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12391 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12392 which stops before the question mark.
12393
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012394req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12395 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12396 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12397 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12398 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012400req.ver : string
12401req_ver : string (deprecated)
12402 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12403 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12404 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012406 ACL derivatives :
12407 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012409res.comp : boolean
12410 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12411 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12412 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012414res.comp_algo : string
12415 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12416 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12417 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012419res.cook([<name>]) : string
12420scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12421 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12422 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12423 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425 ACL derivatives :
12426 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012428res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12429scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12430 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12431 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12432 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012434res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12435scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12436 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12437 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12438 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012440res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12441 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12442 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12443 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12444 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12445 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12446 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12447 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12448 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12449 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12452 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12453 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12454 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12455 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12456 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012458res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12459shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12460 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12461 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12462 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12463 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12464 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12465 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12466 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12467 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012469 ACL derivatives :
12470 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12471 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12472 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12473 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12474 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12475 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12476 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12477 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12478
12479res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12480shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12481 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12482 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12483 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12484 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12485 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012487res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12488shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12489 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12490 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12491 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12492 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12493 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12494 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012495
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012496res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12497 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12498 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12499 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12500 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012502res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12503shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12504 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12505 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12506 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12507 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12508 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12509 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012511res.ver : string
12512resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12513 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12514 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012516 ACL derivatives :
12517 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12520 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12521 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12522 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12523 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012525 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12526 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012530status : integer
12531 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12532 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12533 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012535url : string
12536 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12537 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12538 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12539 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12540 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12541 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12542 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012544 ACL derivatives :
12545 url : exact string match
12546 url_beg : prefix match
12547 url_dir : subdir match
12548 url_dom : domain match
12549 url_end : suffix match
12550 url_len : length match
12551 url_reg : regex match
12552 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012554url_ip : ip
12555 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12556 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12557 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12558 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12559 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12560 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12561 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012563url_port : integer
12564 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12565 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12566 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12567 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12570url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12571 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12572 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12573 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12574 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12575 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12576 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12577 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12578 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12579 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012581 ACL derivatives :
12582 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12583 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12584 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12585 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12586 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12587 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12588 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12589 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012590
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592 Example :
12593 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12594 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12595 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12596 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012598urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12599 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12600 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12601 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012602
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126047.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012605---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012607Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12608every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012609order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012611ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12612---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012613FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012614HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012615HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12616HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012617HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12618HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12619HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12620HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12621LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012622METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12623METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12624METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12625METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12626METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12627METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012628RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012629REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012630TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012631WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12632---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012633
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126358. Logging
12636----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012637
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012638One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12639provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12640very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12641provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12642state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012643to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012644headers.
12645
12646In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12647about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12648send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12649
12650 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12651 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12652 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12653 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12654 at the termination.
12655
12656The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12657allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12658as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12659while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12660real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12661delay.
12662
12663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126648.1. Log levels
12665---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012666
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012667TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012668source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012669HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12670in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12671track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12672syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12673about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012674
12675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126768.2. Log formats
12677----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012678
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012679HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012680and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12681slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12682options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012683
12684 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12685 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12686 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12687 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12688 extents.
12689
12690 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12691 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12692 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12693 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12694 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12695
12696 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12697 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12698 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12699 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12700 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12701
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012702 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12703 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12704 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12705 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12706
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012707 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012709Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12710specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12711field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12712servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12713always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12714identifier.
12715
12716Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12717 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12718 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12719 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12720 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12721
12722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127238.2.1. Default log format
12724-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012725
12726This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12727as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12728format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12729
12730 Example :
12731 listen www
12732 mode http
12733 log global
12734 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12735
12736 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12737 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12738 (www/HTTP)
12739
12740 Field Format Extract from the example above
12741 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12742 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12743 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12744 4 'to' to
12745 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12746 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12747
12748Detailed fields description :
12749 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12750 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12751 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12752 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12753 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12754 and processed the connection.
12755 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12756
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012757In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12758"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12759connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12760
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012761It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12762will eventually disappear.
12763
12764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127658.2.2. TCP log format
12766---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012767
12768The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12769is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12770information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12771counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12772emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12773environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12774the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12775sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012776specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12777not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12778fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12779marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012780
12781 Example :
12782 frontend fnt
12783 mode tcp
12784 option tcplog
12785 log global
12786 default_backend bck
12787
12788 backend bck
12789 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12790
12791 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12792 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12793 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12794
12795 Field Format Extract from the example above
12796 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12797 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12798 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12799 4 frontend_name fnt
12800 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12801 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12802 7 bytes_read* 212
12803 8 termination_state --
12804 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12805 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12806
12807Detailed fields description :
12808 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012809 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12810 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12811 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12812 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12813 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012814
12815 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012816 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12817 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12818 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012819
12820 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12821 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12822 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12823 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12824
12825 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12826 and processed the connection.
12827
12828 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12829 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12830 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12831 applications.
12832
12833 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12834 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12835 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12836 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12837 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12838
12839 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12840 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12841 See "Timers" below for more details.
12842
12843 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12844 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12845 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12846 "Timers" below for more details.
12847
12848 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012849 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012850 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12851 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12852 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12853 details.
12854
12855 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12856 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12857 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12858 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12859 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12860
12861 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12862 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12863 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12864 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12865 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12866 for more details.
12867
12868 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012869 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012870 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12871 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12872 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012873 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012874
12875 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12876 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12877 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12878 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12879 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12880 caused by a denial of service attack.
12881
12882 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12883 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12884 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12885 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12886 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12887 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12888 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12889 denial of service attack.
12890
12891 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12892 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12893 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12894 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12895 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12896 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12897 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12898 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12899 be processed than on other servers.
12900
12901 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12902 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12903 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12904 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12905 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12906 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12907 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12908 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12909 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12910 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12911 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12912 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12913 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12914
12915 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12916 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12917 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12918 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12919 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12920 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12921 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12922 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12923
12924 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12925 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12926 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12927 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12928 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12929 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12930 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12931 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12932 occurs.
12933
12934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129358.2.3. HTTP log format
12936----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012937
12938The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12939is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12940the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12941are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12942emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12943generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12944"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12945which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012946frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12947is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012948
12949Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12950slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12951with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12952
12953 Example :
12954 frontend http-in
12955 mode http
12956 option httplog
12957 log global
12958 default_backend bck
12959
12960 backend static
12961 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12962
12963 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12964 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12965 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012966 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012967
12968 Field Format Extract from the example above
12969 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12970 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12971 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12972 4 frontend_name http-in
12973 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12974 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12975 7 status_code 200
12976 8 bytes_read* 2750
12977 9 captured_request_cookie -
12978 10 captured_response_cookie -
12979 11 termination_state ----
12980 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12981 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12982 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12983 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12984 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012986
12987Detailed fields description :
12988 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012989 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12990 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12991 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12992 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12993 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012994
12995 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012996 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12997 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12998 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012999
13000 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13001 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13002 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13003 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13004 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13005
13006 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13007 and processed the connection.
13008
13009 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13010 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13011 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13012
13013 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13014 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13015 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13016 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13017 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13018 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13019
13020 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13021 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13022 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13023 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13024 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13025 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13026
13027 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13028 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13029 See "Timers" below for more details.
13030
13031 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13032 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13033 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13034 below for more details.
13035
13036 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13037 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13038 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13039 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13040 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13041 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13042 for more details.
13043
13044 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013045 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013046 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13047 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13048 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13049 details.
13050
13051 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13052 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13053 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13054
13055 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13056 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13057 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13058 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13059 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13060 overflowing.
13061
13062 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13063 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13064 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13065 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13066 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13067 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13068 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13069 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13070
13071 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13072 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13073 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13074 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13075 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13076 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13077 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13078 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13079
13080 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13081 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13082 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13083 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13084 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13085 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13086 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13087
13088 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013089 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013090 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13091 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13092 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013093 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013094 system.
13095
13096 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13097 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13098 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13099 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13100 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13101 caused by a denial of service attack.
13102
13103 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13104 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13105 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13106 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13107 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13108 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13109 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13110 denial of service attack.
13111
13112 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13113 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13114 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13115 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13116 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13117 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13118 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13119 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13120 processed than on other servers.
13121
13122 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13123 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13124 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13125 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13126 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13127 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13128 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13129 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13130 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13131 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13132 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13133 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13134 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13135
13136 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13137 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13138 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13139 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13140 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13141 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13142 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13143 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13144
13145 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13146 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13147 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13148 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13149 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13150 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13151 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13152 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13153 occurs.
13154
13155 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13156 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13157 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13158 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13159 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13160 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13161 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13162 cookies" below for more details.
13163
13164 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13165 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13166 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13167 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13168 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13169 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13170 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13171 and cookies" below for more details.
13172
13173 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13174 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13175 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13176 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13177 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13178 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13179 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13180 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13181
13182
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200131838.2.4. Custom log format
13184------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013185
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013186The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013187mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013188
13189HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13190Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13191separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13192prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13193
13194Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13195variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13196string formats ("Q").
13197
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013198If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013199as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013200less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13201the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13202
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013203Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013204In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013205in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013206
13207Flags are :
13208 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013209 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013210
13211 Example:
13212
13213 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13214 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13215
13216At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13217
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013218 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13219 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013220
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013221the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013222
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013223 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013224 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013225 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013226
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013227and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13228
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013229 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013230 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13231
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013232Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13233
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013234 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013235 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013236 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13237 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13238 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013239 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13240 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13241 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013242 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013243 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13244 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13245 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13246 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013247 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013248 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013249 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013250 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013251 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013252 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13253 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013254 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013255 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13256 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013257 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013258 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13259 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013260 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13261 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13262 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013263 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013264 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13265 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013266 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013267 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13268 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13269 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013270 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013271 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013272 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13273 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13274 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13275 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013276 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013277 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013278 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013279 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013280 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013281 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013282 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13283 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13284 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013285 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013286 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13287 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013288 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013289 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013290 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013291 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013292
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013293 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013294
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013295
132968.2.5. Error log format
13297-----------------------
13298
13299When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13300protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13301By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13302"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13303will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13304logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13305
13306The format looks like this :
13307
13308 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13309 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13310 Connection error during SSL handshake
13311
13312 Field Format Extract from the example above
13313 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13314 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13315 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13316 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13317 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13318
13319These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13320failures.
13321
13322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133238.3. Advanced logging options
13324-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013325
13326Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13327just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13328options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13329for more information about their usage.
13330
13331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133328.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13333------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013334
13335It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13336haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13337commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13338monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13339ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13340
13341 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13342 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13343 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13344 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13345
13346 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13347 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13348 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013349 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013350 such as other load-balancers.
13351
13352 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13353 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13354 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13355
13356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133578.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13358----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013359
13360The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13361what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13362or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13363"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13364just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13365log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13366after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13367is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13368with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13369with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13370
13371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133728.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13373------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013374
13375Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13376for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13377"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13378retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13379raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13380a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13381file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13382you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13383"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13384
13385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13387--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013388
13389Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13390multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13391them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13392"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13393logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13394error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13395and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13396too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13397useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13398alternative.
13399
13400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134018.4. Timing events
13402------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013403
13404Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13405reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13406the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13407frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13408mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13409
13410 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13411 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13412 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13413 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13414 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13415
13416 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13417 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13418 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13419 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13420 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13421
13422 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13423 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13424 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13425 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13426 connection never established.
13427
13428 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13429 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13430 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13431 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13432 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13433 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13434 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13435 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13436 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13437 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13438 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13439
13440 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13441 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13442 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13443 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013444 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013445
13446 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13447
13448 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13449 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13450 negative.
13451
13452These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13453protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13454that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013455due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013456close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13457session has been aborted on timeout.
13458
13459Most common cases :
13460
13461 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13462 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13463 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13464 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13465 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13466 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13467 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13468 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13469 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013470 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13471 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13472 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013473
13474 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13475 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13476 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13477 of ms on remote networks.
13478
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013479 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13480 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13481 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013482
13483 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13484 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13485 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13486 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13487 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13488 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13489 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13490 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13491 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13492 to the server until another one is released.
13493
13494Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13495
13496 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13497 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13498 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13499
13500 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13501 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13502 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13503
13504 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13505 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13506 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13507 flags.
13508
13509 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13510 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13511 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13512 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13513 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13514 the client connection was maintained open.
13515
13516 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013517 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013518 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13519 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13520
13521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135228.5. Session state at disconnection
13523-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013524
13525TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13526"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
135272-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13528each of which has a special meaning :
13529
13530 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13531 session to terminate :
13532
13533 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13534
13535 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13536 server explicitly refused it.
13537
13538 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13539 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13540 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13541 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013542 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13543
13544 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13545 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013546
13547 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13548 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13549 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13550 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13551 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13552
13553 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13554 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13555 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13556 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13557 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13558
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013559 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13560 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13561
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013562 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13563 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13564 backup connections when going up.
13565
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013566 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13567
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013568 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13569 send or receive data.
13570
13571 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13572 send or receive data.
13573
13574 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13575 with nothing left in the buffers.
13576
13577 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13578
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013579 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013580 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13581
13582 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13583 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13584 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13585 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13586 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13587
13588 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13589 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13590
13591 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13592 server (HTTP only).
13593
13594 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13595
13596 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13597 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13598 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13599
13600 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13601 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13602 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13603
13604 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13605
13606 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13607 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13608
13609 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13610 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13611 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13612
13613 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13614 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013615 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13616 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013617
13618 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13619 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13620 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13621 another server.
13622
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013623 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013624 server.
13625
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013626 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13627 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13628 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13629 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13630
13631 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13632 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13633 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13634 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13635
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013636 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13637 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13638 "use-server" rule).
13639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013640 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13641
13642 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13643 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13644
13645 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13646
13647 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13648 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13649 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13650
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013651 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13652 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013653 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013654 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13655 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13656
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013657 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13658
13659 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13660 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13661
13662 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13663
13664 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13665
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013666The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13667was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013668helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13669starvation, attacks, etc...
13670
13671The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13672alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13673easier finding and understanding.
13674
13675 Flags Reason
13676
13677 -- Normal termination.
13678
13679 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13680 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13681 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13682 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13683
13684 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13685 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13686 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13687 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13688 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13689 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013690
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013691 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13692 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013693 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013694
13695 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13696 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13697 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13698
13699 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13700 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13701 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13702 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13703 the server takes too long to respond.
13704
13705 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13706 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13707 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13708 long a time to respond.
13709
13710 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13711 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13712 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13713 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013714 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
13715 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013716
13717 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13718 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13719 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13720 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13721 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013722 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013723 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
13724 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
13725 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
13726 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
13727 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
13728 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
13729 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
13730 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
13731 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
13732 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
13733 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
13734 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013735
13736 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13737 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013738 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13739 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13740 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13741 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013742
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013743 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13744 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013746 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013747 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13748 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13749 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13750 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13751 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13752
13753 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13754 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13755 503 or 504 here.
13756
13757 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13758 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13759 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13760 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13761 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13762
13763 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13764 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013765 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013766 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13767 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13768
13769 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13770 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13771 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13772 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13773 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13774 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13775 between haproxy and the server.
13776
13777 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13778 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13779 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13780 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13781 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13782 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13783 solution is to fix the application.
13784
13785 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13786 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13787 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13788 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13789 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13790 external attacks.
13791
13792 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13793 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013794 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013795 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13796 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13797
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013798 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13799 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13800 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013801 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13802 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013804 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13805 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13806 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13807 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013808 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13809 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13810 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13811 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13812 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013813
13814 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13815 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13816 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13817 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13818
13819 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13820 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13821 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13822 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13823
13824 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13825 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13826 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13827 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13828
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013829The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13830persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13831important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13832re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13833
13834 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13835
13836 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13837 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13838 set on a GET request.
13839
13840 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13841 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013842 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013843 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13844
13845 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13846 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13847 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13848
13849 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13850 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13851 already got a cookie.
13852
13853 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13854 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13855 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13856 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13857 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13858
13859 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13860 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13861 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13862
13863 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13864 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13865 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13866
13867 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13868 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13869
13870 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13871 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13872 then advertised in the response.
13873
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138758.6. Non-printable characters
13876-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013877
13878In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13879consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13880converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13881prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13882being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13883escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13884is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13885'}' when logging headers.
13886
13887Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13888issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13889containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13890
13891Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13892the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13893performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13894
13895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13897---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013898
13899Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13900achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013901section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013902cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13903the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13904the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013905locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013906not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13907user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13908a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13909wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13910
13911 Examples :
13912 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13913 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13914
13915 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13916 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13917
13918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139198.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13920---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013921
13922Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13923proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13924the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13925server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13926
13927Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13928response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013929section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013930
13931It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013932time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13933appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013934are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13935and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13936follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13937request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13938in the logs.
13939
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013940As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13941frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13942an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13943
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013944 Example :
13945 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13946 listen proxy-out
13947 mode http
13948 option httplog
13949 option logasap
13950 log global
13951 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13952
13953 # log the name of the virtual server
13954 capture request header Host len 20
13955
13956 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13957 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13958
13959 # log the beginning of the referrer
13960 capture request header Referer len 20
13961
13962 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13963 capture response header Server len 20
13964
13965 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13966 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13967
13968 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13969 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13970
13971 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13972 capture response header Via len 20
13973
13974 # log the URL location during a redirection
13975 capture response header Location len 20
13976
13977 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13978 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13979 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13980 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13981 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13982
13983 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13984 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13985 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13986 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013987 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013988
13989 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13990 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13991 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13992 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13993 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013994 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013995
13996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139978.9. Examples of logs
13998---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013999
14000These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14001them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14002reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14003
14004 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14005 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14006 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14007
14008 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14009 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14010
14011 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14012 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14013 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14014
14015 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14016 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14017
14018 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14019 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14020 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14021
14022 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014023 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014024 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14025 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14026
14027 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14028 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14029 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14030
14031 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14032 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014033 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014034 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14035 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14036 to return the 502 and not the server.
14037
14038 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014039 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014040
14041 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14042 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14043 Nothing was sent to any server.
14044
14045 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14046 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14047
14048 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14049 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14050 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14051 send a 408 return code to the client.
14052
14053 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14054 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14055
14056 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14057 5 seconds ("c----").
14058
14059 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14060 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014061 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014062
14063 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014064 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014065 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14066 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14067 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14068 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14069 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014070
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140729. Statistics and monitoring
14073----------------------------
14074
14075It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14076mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14077CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14078Unix socket.
14079
14080
140819.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014082---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014083
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014084The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014085page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14086begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14087represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14088use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14089('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14090(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14091text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14092do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14093use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014094
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014095In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14096that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14097S (Servers).
14098
14099 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14100 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14101 any name for server/listener)
14102 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14103 number queued without a server assigned.
14104 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14105 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14106 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14107 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14108 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14109 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14110 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14111 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14112 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14113 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14114 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14115 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14116 "option checkcache".
14117 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14118 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14119 - read error from the client
14120 - client timeout
14121 - client closed connection
14122 - various bad requests from the client.
14123 - request was tarpitted.
14124 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14125 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14126 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14127 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14128 active servers).
14129 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14130 Some other errors are:
14131 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14132 - failure applying filters to the response.
14133 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14134 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14135 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14136 switched away from.
14137 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
14138 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
14139 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
14140 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
14141 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14142 the server is up.)
14143 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14144 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14145 counters for each server.
14146 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14147 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14148 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14149 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14150 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14151 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14152 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14153 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14154 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14155 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14156 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14157 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14158 of times that server was selected.
14159 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14160 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14161 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14162 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14163 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14164 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014165 UNK -> unknown
14166 INI -> initializing
14167 SOCKERR -> socket error
14168 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014169 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014170 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14171 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14172 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14173 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14174 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14175 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14176 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14177 disable-on-404
14178 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14179 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14180 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014181 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14182 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14183 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14184 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14185 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14186 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14187 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14188 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14189 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14190 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14191 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14192 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14193 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14194 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14195 (inc. in eresp)
14196 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14197 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14198 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14199 (CPU/BW limit)
14200 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14201 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14202 server/backend
14203 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14204 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14205 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14206 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14207 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14208 (0 for TCP)
14209 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14210 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014211
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142139.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014214-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014215
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014216The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14217necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14218A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14219issuing commands by hand :
14220
14221 global
14222 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14223 stats timeout 2m
14224
14225It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14226the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14227never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14228situations :
14229
14230 global
14231 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14232 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14233 stats timeout 2m
14234
14235To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14236swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14237to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14238syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14239
14240 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14241 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14242
14243The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14244script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14245for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14246
14247The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14248that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14249editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14250(eg: watch a counter).
14251
14252The socket supports two operation modes :
14253 - interactive
14254 - non-interactive
14255
14256The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14257this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14258sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14259mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14260commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14261example :
14262
14263 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14264
14265The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14266entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14267for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14268sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14269"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14270after processing the last command of the same line.
14271
14272For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14273"prompt" command :
14274
14275 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14276 prompt
14277 > show info
14278 ...
14279 >
14280
14281Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14282delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14283that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14284parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014285
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014286It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14287on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14288own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014289
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014290The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14291If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14292all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14293it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14294
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014295add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014296 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14297 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14298 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14299 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014300
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014301add map <map> <key> <value>
14302 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14303 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014304 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14305 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14306 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014307
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014308clear counters
14309 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14310 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14311 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14312 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14313 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14314
14315clear counters all
14316 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14317 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14318 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14319
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014320clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014321 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14322 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14323 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014324
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014325clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014326 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14327 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14328 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014329
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014330clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14331 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14332
14333 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14334 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14335 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14336 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14337 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14338 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14339
14340 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14341
14342 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14343 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14344 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14345 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14346 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14347 the ACLs :
14348
14349 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14350 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14351 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14352 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14353 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14354 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14355
14356 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014357 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14358 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014359
14360 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014361 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014362 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014363 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14364 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14365 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14366 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014367
14368 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14369
14370 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014371 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014372 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14373 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014374 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14375 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14376 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014377
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014378del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14379 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014380 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14381 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14382 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14383 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014384
14385del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014386 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014387 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14388 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14389 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14390 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014391
14392disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014393 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14394
14395 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14396 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14397 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14398 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14399 re-enabled using enable agent.
14400
14401 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14402 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14403 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14404 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14405 otherwise unchanged.
14406
14407 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14408 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14409 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14410
14411 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14412 level "admin".
14413
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014414disable frontend <frontend>
14415 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14416 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14417 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14418 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14419 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14420 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14421 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14422 on the stats page.
14423
14424 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14425 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14426
14427 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14428 level "admin".
14429
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014430disable health <backend>/<server>
14431 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14432 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14433 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14434 agent check forces it down.
14435
14436 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14437 level "admin".
14438
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014439disable server <backend>/<server>
14440 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14441 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14442 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14443 during the maintenance.
14444
14445 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14446 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14447
14448 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014449 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014450
14451 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14452 level "admin".
14453
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014454enable agent <backend>/<server>
14455 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14456
14457 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14458 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14459
14460 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14461 level "admin".
14462
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014463enable frontend <frontend>
14464 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14465 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14466 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14467 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14468 which was disabled.
14469
14470 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14471 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14472
14473 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14474 level "admin".
14475
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014476enable health <backend>/<server>
14477 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14478 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14479
14480 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14481 level "admin".
14482
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014483enable server <backend>/<server>
14484 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14485 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14486
14487 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014488 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014489
14490 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14491 level "admin".
14492
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014493get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014494get acl <acl> <value>
14495 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14496 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14497 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14498 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14499 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014500
14501 The first two words are:
14502
14503 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14504 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14505 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14506
14507 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14508
14509 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14510
14511 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14512
14513 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14514 interpretation of the case.
14515
14516 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14517 useful with regular expressions.
14518
14519 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14520 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14521
14522 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14523 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14524 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14525
14526 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14527
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014528get weight <backend>/<server>
14529 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14530 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14531 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14532 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14533 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014534 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014535
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014536help
14537 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14538 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014539
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014540prompt
14541 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14542 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14543 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14544 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14545 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14546 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14547 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14548 command.
14549
14550quit
14551 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014552
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014553set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014554 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14555 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14556 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014557
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014558set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014559 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14560 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14561 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14562 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14563 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014564 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14565 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14566
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014567set maxconn global <maxconn>
14568 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14569 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14570 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14571 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14572 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14573 setting.
14574
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014575set rate-limit connections global <value>
14576 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14577 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14578 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14579 is passed in number of connections per second.
14580
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014581set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14582 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14583 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014584 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14585 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014586
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014587set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14588 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14589 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14590 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14591 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14592
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014593set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14594 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14595 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14596 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14597 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14598 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14599
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014600set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14601 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14602 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14603 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14604
14605set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14606 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14607 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14608 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14609
14610set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14611 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14612 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14613 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14614 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14615 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14616 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14617 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14618 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14619
14620set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14621 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14622 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14623
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014624set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14625 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14626 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14627 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14628 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14629
14630 Example:
14631 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14632 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14633 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14634 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14635
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014636set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014637 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14638 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14639 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14640 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014641 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14642 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014643
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014644set timeout cli <delay>
14645 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14646 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14647 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14648
14649set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14650 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14651 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014652 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14653 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14654 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14655 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14656 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14657 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14658 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14659 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14660 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14661 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14662 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14663 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14664 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014665
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014666show errors [<iid>]
14667 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14668 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014669 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14670 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14671 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014672
14673 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14674 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14675 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14676 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14677 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14678 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14679 are reported too.
14680
14681 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14682 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14683 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14684 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14685 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14686 code.
14687
14688 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14689 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14690 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14691 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14692 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14693 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14694 line.
14695
14696 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014697 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14698 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014699 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14700 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14701
14702 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14703 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14704 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14705 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14706 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14707 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14708 00204+ minal\r\n
14709 00211 \r\n
14710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014711 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014712 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14713 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14714 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14715 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14716 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14717 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014718
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014719show info
14720 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14721
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014722show map [<map>]
14723 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014724 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14725 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14726 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14727 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14728 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14729 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014730
14731show acl [<acl>]
14732 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014733 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14734 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14735 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14736 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14737 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014738
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014739show pools
14740 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14741 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14742 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14743 the pools.
14744
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014745show sess
14746 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014747 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14748 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14749
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014750show sess <id>
14751 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14752 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14753 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14754 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14755 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014756 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14757 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14758
14759 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14760 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014761
14762show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14763 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14764 possible to dump only selected items :
14765 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14766 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14767 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14768 for example:
14769 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14770 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14771 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14772
14773 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014774 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14775 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014776 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14777 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14778 Nbproc: 1
14779 Process_num: 1
14780 (...)
14781
14782 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14783 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14784 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14785 (...)
14786 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14787
14788 $
14789
14790 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14791 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14792 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14793 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014794 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014795
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014796show table
14797 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14798 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14799 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14800 entries currently in use.
14801
14802 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014803 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014804 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14805 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014806
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014807show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014808 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14809 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14810 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014811 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14812
14813 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14814 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14815 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14816 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14817 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14818
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014819 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14820 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14821 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14822 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14823 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14824 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14825
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014826
14827 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014828 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14829 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014830
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014831 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014832 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014833 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014834 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14835 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14836 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14837 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014838
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014839 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014840 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014841 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14842 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014843
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014844 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14845 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014846 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014847 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14848 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014849
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014850 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14851 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014852 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014853 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14854 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14855
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014856 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14857 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14858 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14859 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14860 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14861
14862 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14863 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14864 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014865 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14866 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014867 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14868 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014869
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014870shutdown frontend <frontend>
14871 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14872 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14873 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14874 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14875 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14876 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14877 once it is terminated.
14878
14879 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14880 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14881
14882 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14883 level "admin".
14884
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014885shutdown session <id>
14886 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14887 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14888 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14889 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14890 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14891 flag in the logs.
14892
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014893shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014894 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14895 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14896 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14897 'K' flag in the logs.
14898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014899/*
14900 * Local variables:
14901 * fill-column: 79
14902 * End:
14903 */